blob: ec89073888e0f738309b9249f07fc3b55c3baed9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreauf8e32182023-02-14 16:57:13 +01006 2023/02/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100756* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
757 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
758 updating the binary and reloading.
759
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200760In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
761regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
762only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
763
764* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
765
766* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
767 starting at one.
768
769* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
770 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
771 first section.
772
773These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
774if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
775section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
776"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
777proxies.
778
779This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
780logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
781to name some config objects like servers for example.
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200784
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100785
7862.4. Conditional blocks
787-----------------------
788
789It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
790some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
791ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
792configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
793versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
794preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
795text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
796lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
797switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
798are defined to form conditional blocks:
799
800 - .if <condition>
801 - .elif <condition>
802 - .else
803 - .endif
804
805The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
806as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
807matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
808there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
809only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
810".elif" of a block.
811
812Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
813ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
814as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
815
816The conditions are currently limited to:
817
818 - an empty string, always returns "false"
819 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
820 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200821 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
822
823The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
824
825 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
826 exists, regardless of its contents
827
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200828 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
829 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
830 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
831
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200832 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
833 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
834
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200835 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
836 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
837 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
838 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
839
840 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
841 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
842 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
843 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
844
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200845Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100846
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200847 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
848 listen mwcli_px
849 bind :1111
850 ...
851 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100852
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200853 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
854 bind :80
855 .endif
856
857 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200858 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200859 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200860 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200863 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
864 profiling.memory on
865 .endif
866
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200867Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100868
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200869 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100870 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
871 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
872 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
873
874Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
875"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
876fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
877provide advice to the user.
878
879Example:
880
881 .if "${A}"
882 .if "${B}"
883 .notice "A=1, B=1"
884 .elif "${C}"
885 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
886 .elif "${D}"
887 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
888 .else
889 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
890 .endif
891 .else
892 .notice "A=0"
893 .endif
894
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200895 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
896 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
897
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100898
8992.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200900----------------
901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100902Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100903values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
904otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
905numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
906for every keyword. Supported units are :
907
908 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
909 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
910 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
911 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
912 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
913 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
914
915
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009162.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200917-------------
918
919 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
920 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
921 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
922 global
923 daemon
924 maxconn 256
925
926 defaults
927 mode http
928 timeout connect 5000ms
929 timeout client 50000ms
930 timeout server 50000ms
931
932 frontend http-in
933 bind *:80
934 default_backend servers
935
936 backend servers
937 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
938
939
940 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
941 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
942 global
943 daemon
944 maxconn 256
945
946 defaults
947 mode http
948 timeout connect 5000ms
949 timeout client 50000ms
950 timeout server 50000ms
951
952 listen http-in
953 bind *:80
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
958
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100959 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200960
961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009623. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963--------------------
964
965Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
966are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
967of them have command-line equivalents.
968
969The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
970
971 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100972 - 51degrees-cache-size
973 - 51degrees-data-file
974 - 51degrees-property-name-list
975 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200976 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200978 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100979 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200981 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200982 - description
983 - deviceatlas-json-file
984 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200985 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100986 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200987 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900988 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200989 - gid
990 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200991 - h1-case-adjust
992 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100993 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
994 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100995 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100996 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100997 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200998 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001000 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001001 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001003 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001004 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001005 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001007 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001009 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001011 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001012 - presetenv
1013 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001014 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001015 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001016 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001017 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001019 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001020 - ssl-default-bind-options
1021 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001022 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001023 - ssl-default-server-options
1024 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001025 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001026 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001027 - stats
1028 - strict-limits
1029 - uid
1030 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001031 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001032 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001033 - user
1034 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001035 - wurfl-data-file
1036 - wurfl-information-list
1037 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001038
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001039 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001040 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001041 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001042 - maxcompcpuusage
1043 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001044 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001045 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001046 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001047 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001048 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001049 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001050 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001051 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001053 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001054 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001055 - nokqueue
1056 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001057 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001058 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001059 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001060 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001061 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001062 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001063 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001064 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001065 - tune.buffers.limit
1066 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001067 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001068 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001069 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001070 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001071 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001072 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001073 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001074 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001075 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001076 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001077 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001078 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001079 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001080 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001081 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1083 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001084 - tune.maxaccept
1085 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001086 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001087 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001088 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001089 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1090 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001091 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1092 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001093 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001094 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001095 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001096 - tune.sndbuf.client
1097 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001098 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001099 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1100 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1101 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001102 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001103 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1104 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001105 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001106 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001107 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001108 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1109 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1110 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001111 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1112 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001113
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001116 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001117
1118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011193.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001120------------------------------------
1121
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100112251degrees-data-file <file path>
1123 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1124 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1125
1126 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1127 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1128
112951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1130 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1131 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1132 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1133
1134 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1135 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1136
113751degrees-property-separator <char>
1138 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1139 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1140
1141 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1142 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1143
114451degrees-cache-size <number>
1145 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1146 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1147 By default, this cache is disabled.
1148
1149 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1150 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1151
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001152ca-base <dir>
1153 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001154 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1155 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1156 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001157
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158chroot <jail dir>
1159 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1160 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1161 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1162 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1163 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001164 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001165
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001166cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1167 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1168 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1169 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1170 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1171 set. These sets have the format
1172
1173 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1174
1175 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001177 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1178 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001179 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1180 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001181 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1182 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1183 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1184 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1185 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1186 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1187 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1188 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1189 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1190 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001191
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001192 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1193 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1194 on the machine's word size.
1195
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001196 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001197 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1198 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1199 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1200 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1201 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1202 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001203
1204 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001205 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1206
1207 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1208 # first 4 CPUs
1209
1210 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1211 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1212 # word size.
1213
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001214 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001215 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001216 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1217 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1218 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1219
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001220 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1221 # and so on.
1222 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1223 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1224 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1225
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001226 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001227 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1228 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1229 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1230
1231 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1232 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1233 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1234
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001235 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1236 # and a thread range.
1237 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1238 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1239 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1240
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001241crt-base <dir>
1242 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001243 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1244 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246daemon
1247 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1248 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001249 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1250 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001251
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001252default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001253 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001254 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1255 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1256 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1257 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1258 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1259 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1260 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1261 not start with a slash ('/'):
1262 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1263 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1264
1265 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1266 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1267 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1268 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1269 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1270 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1271 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1272 each of them.
1273
1274 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1275 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1276 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1277 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1278 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1279 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1280 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1281 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1282
1283 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1284 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001285 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001286 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1287 made easily relocatable.
1288
1289 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1290 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1291 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1292 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1293 consistent across all configuration files.
1294
1295 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1296 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1297 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1298 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1299 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1300 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1301 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1302 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1303
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001304description <text>
1305 Add a text that describes the instance.
1306
1307 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1308 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1309 "<" and ">" characters.
1310
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001311deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1312 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001313 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001314
1315deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001316 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001317 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1318
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001319deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001320 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1321 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1322 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001323
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001324deviceatlas-separator <char>
1325 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1326 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1327
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001328expose-experimental-directives
1329 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1330 the config file will be rejected.
1331
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001332external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001333 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1334 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001335 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1336 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1337 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1338 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1339 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001340
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001342 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001343 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1344 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001345 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001346 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001347 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001348
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001349group <group name>
1350 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1351 See also "gid" and "user".
1352
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001353h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1354 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1355 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1356 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1357 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001358 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001359 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1360 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1361 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1362 specified in a proxy.
1363
1364 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1365 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1366 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1367 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1368 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1369 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1370 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1371
1372 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1373 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1374 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1375 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1376 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1377
1378 Example:
1379 global
1380 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1381
1382 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1383 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1384
1385h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1386 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1387 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1388 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1389 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1390 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1391 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1392 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1393 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1394
1395 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1396 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1397 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1398
1399 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1400 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1401
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001402h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1403 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1404 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1405 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1406 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1407 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1408 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1409 the keyword with "no'.
1410
1411hard-stop-after <time>
1412 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1413
1414 Arguments :
1415 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1416 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1417 SIGUSR1 signal.
1418
1419 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1420 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1421 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1422
1423 Example:
1424 global
1425 hard-stop-after 30s
1426
1427 See also: grace
1428
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001429insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001430 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001431 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1432 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1433 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1434 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1435 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1436 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1437 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001438 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001439 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1440 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1441 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1442 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1443 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1444 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1445 disable it.
1446
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001447insecure-setuid-wanted
1448 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1449 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1450 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1451 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001452 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001453 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001454 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001455 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1456 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001458 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1459 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1460 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1461 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1462
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001463issuers-chain-path <dir>
1464 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1465 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1466 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001467 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001468 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1469 "issuers-chain-path".
1470 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1471 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1472 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1473 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1474 will share the chain in memory.
1475
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001476localpeer <name>
1477 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1478 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1479 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1480 the configuration parsing.
1481
1482 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1483 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1484
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001485log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001486 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001487 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001488 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001489 configured with "log global".
1490
1491 <address> can be one of:
1492
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001493 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001494 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1495 port).
1496
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001497 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1498 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1499 port).
1500
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001501 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001502 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1503 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001504 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001505
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001506 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1507 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1508 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1509 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1510 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1511 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1512 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1513 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1514 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1515 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001516 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001517 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1518 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1519 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001520 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1521 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001522
1523 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1524 "fd@2", see above.
1525
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001526 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1527 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1528 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1529 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1530 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1531
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001532 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1533 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001534
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001535 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1536 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1537 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1538 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1539 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1540 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1541 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1542 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1543 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1544 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001545 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1546 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001547
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001548 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1549 one of the following :
1550
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001551 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1552 field is stripped. This is the default.
1553 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1554 rfc3164.
1555
1556 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001557 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1558
1559 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1560 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1561
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001562 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1563 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1564 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1565 designed to be used with a local log server.
1566
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001567 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1568 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1569 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1570 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1571 logger consumes.
1572
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001573 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1574 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1575 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1576 used with a local log server.
1577
1578 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1579 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1580 designed to be used with a local log server.
1581
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001582 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1583 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1584 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1585 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1586
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001587 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1588 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1589 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1590 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1591 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1592
1593 <sample_size>
1594 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1595 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1596 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1597 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1598 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1599
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001600 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001602 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1603 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1604 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1605
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001606 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1607 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1608 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1609 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001610
1611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001621log-send-hostname [<string>]
1622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1626 the logs.
1627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001628log-tag <string>
1629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001632 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001633
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001634lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001635 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1636 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1637 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1638 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1639 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1640 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001641 used multiple times.
1642
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001643lua-load-per-thread <file>
1644 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1645 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1646 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1647 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1648 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1649 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1650 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1651 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1652 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1653 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1654 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1655 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1656 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1657 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1658 times.
1659
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001660lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1661 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1662 variable.
1663 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1664 to "path".
1665
1666 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1667 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1668 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1669 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1670 will be checked earlier.
1671
1672 As an example by specifying the following path:
1673
1674 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1675 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1676
1677 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1678 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1679 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1680 paths if that does not exist either.
1681
1682 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1683 documentation.
1684
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001685master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001686 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1687 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1688 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001689 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001690 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1691 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001692 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1693 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1694 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1695 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1696 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001697
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001698 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001699
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001700mworker-max-reloads <number>
1701 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001702 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001703 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1704 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1705 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1706
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001707nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001708 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1709 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1710 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001711 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1712 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001713 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1714 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1715 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001716
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001717nbthread <number>
1718 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001719 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001720 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1721 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1722 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1723 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001724 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1725 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1726 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1727 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1728 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1729 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1730 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001731
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001732numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001733 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001734 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1735 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1736 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1737 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1738 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1739 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1740 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1741 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1742
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001743pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001744 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1745 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1746 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1747 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001748
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001749pp2-never-send-local
1750 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1751 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1752 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1753 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1754 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1755 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1756 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1757 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1758 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1759 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1760 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1761
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001762presetenv <name> <value>
1763 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1764 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1765 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1766 and "unsetenv".
1767
1768resetenv [<name> ...]
1769 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1770 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1771 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1772 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1773 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1774 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1775 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1776 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1777
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001778stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001779 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1780 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1781 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1782 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1783 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1784 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001785 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001786 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1787 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1788 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1789 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001790
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001791server-state-base <directory>
1792 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001793 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1794 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001795
1796server-state-file <file>
1797 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1798 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1799 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1800 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1801 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1802 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1803 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1804 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001805 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1806 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001807
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001808set-dumpable
1809 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1810 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1811 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1812 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1813 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1814 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1815 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1816 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1817 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1818 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1819 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1820 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1821 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1822 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1823 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1824 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1825 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1826 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1827
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001828set-var <var-name> <expr>
1829 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1830 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1831 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1832 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1833 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1834 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1835 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1836 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1837 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1838
1839 Example:
1840 global
1841 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1842 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1843 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1844
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001845setenv <name> <value>
1846 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1847 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1848 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1849 and "unsetenv".
1850
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001851ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1853 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001854 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001855 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001856 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1857 information and recommendations see e.g.
1858 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1859 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1860 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1861 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001862
1863ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1865 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1866 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1867 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1868 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001869 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1870 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1871 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001872 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001873
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001874ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1876 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1877 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1878 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1879 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1880
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001881ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1883 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1884 keyword to see available options.
1885
1886 Example:
1887 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001888 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001889
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001890ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1892 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001893 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001894 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001895 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1896 information and recommendations see e.g.
1897 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1898 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1899 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1900 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1901 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001902
1903ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1904 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1905 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1906 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1907 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1908 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001909 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1910 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1911 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1912 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001913
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001914ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1916 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1917 keyword to see available options.
1918
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001919ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1921 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1922 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001924 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001925 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1926 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1927 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1928 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001929 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1930 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1931 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1932
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001933ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1934 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1935 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001936 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001937 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001938 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1939
1940 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001941
1942 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1943 and won't try to remove them.
1944
1945 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1946
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001947ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001949 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1950 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1951 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001952
1953 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1954 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1955 optimize the startup time.
1956
1957 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1958 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1959 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1960
1961 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001962 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001963
1964 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001965 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1966 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001967
1968 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1969 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1970 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1971 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1972 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001973 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001974
1975 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001976 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001977 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1978 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1979 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1980 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1981 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001982 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001983
1984 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1985
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001986 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001987 a cert bundle.
1988
1989 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1990 separately in several "crt".
1991
1992 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1993 since files are loading separately.
1994
1995 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1996 required to commit them.
1997
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001998 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001999 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002000
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002001 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2002 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2003 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002004
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002005 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2006 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2007 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002008
2009 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002010 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2011 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002012
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002013 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2014 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2015
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002016 The default behavior is "all".
2017
2018 Example:
2019 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2020 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2021 ssl-load-extra-files none
2022
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002023 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2024 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002025
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002026ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2027 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2028 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2029 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2030
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002031ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002032 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002033 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2034 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2035 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2036 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2037 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2038 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002039 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002040
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002041stats maxconn <connections>
2042 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2043 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2044
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002045stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2046 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2047 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2048 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002049 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002050 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002051
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002052 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2053 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2054 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002055
2056stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2057 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2058 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002059 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002060
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002061strict-limits
2062 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2063 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2064 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2065 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2066 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002067
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002068uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002069 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002070 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2071 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2072 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2073
2074ulimit-n <number>
2075 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2076 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2077 option.
2078
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002079unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2080 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2081
2082 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2083 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2084 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2085 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2086 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002087 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002088 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2089 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2090 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2091 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2092
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002093unsetenv [<name> ...]
2094 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2095 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2096 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2097 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2098 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2099 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2100 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002102user <user name>
2103 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2104 See also "uid" and "group".
2105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002106node <name>
2107 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2108
2109 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2110 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2111 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2112 traffic.
2113
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002114wurfl-cache-size <size>
2115 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2116 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2117 - "0" : no cache is used.
2118 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002119
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002120 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2121 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002122
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002123wurfl-data-file <file path>
2124 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2125 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2126
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002127 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002128 with USE_WURFL=1.
2129
2130wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2131 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2132 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2133 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2134
2135 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2136
2137 Valid WURFL properties are:
2138 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2139
2140 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2141 device.
2142
2143 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2144 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2145
2146 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2147 particular web request.
2148
2149 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2150 used Libwurfl API version.
2151
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002152 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2153 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2154
2155 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2156 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2157
2158 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2159
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002160 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002161 with USE_WURFL=1.
2162
2163wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2164 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2165 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2166
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002167 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002168 with USE_WURFL=1.
2169
2170wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2171 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2172 thus before the chroot.
2173
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002174 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002175 with USE_WURFL=1.
2176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021773.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002178-----------------------
2179
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002180busy-polling
2181 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2182 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2183 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2184 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2185 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2186 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2187 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2188 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2189 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2190 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2191 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2192 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2193 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2194 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2195 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2196 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2197 "poll" pollers.
2198
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002199 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2200 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2201 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2202
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002203max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002204 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002205 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2206 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2207 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2208 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2209 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2210 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2211 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2212
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002213maxcompcpuusage <number>
2214 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2215 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2216 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2217 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2218 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2219 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2220 and from introducing high latencies.
2221
2222maxcomprate <number>
2223 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2224 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2225 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2226 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2227 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2228 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2229 default value.
2230
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002231maxconn <number>
2232 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2233 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2234 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002235 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2236 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2237 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2238 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002239 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2240 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2241 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2242 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2243 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2244 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002245
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002246maxconnrate <number>
2247 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2248 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2249 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2250 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2251 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2252 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2253 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2254 fairness.
2255
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002256maxpipes <number>
2257 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2258 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2259 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2260 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2261 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2262 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2263
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002264maxsessrate <number>
2265 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2266 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2267 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2268 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2269 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2270 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2271 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2272 fairness.
2273
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002274maxsslconn <number>
2275 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2276 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2277 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2278 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2279 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2280 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2281 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002282 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2283 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2284 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2285 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002286 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002287 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2288 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002289
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002290maxsslrate <number>
2291 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2292 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2293 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2294 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2295 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2296 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2297 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2298 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2299 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2300 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2301
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002302maxzlibmem <number>
2303 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2304 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2305 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002306 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2307 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2308 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2309
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002310no-memory-trimming
2311 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2312 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2313 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2314 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2315 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2316 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2317 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2318 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2319 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2320 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2321 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2322 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2323 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2324 not suffer from such a problem.
2325
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002326noepoll
2327 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2328 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002329 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002330
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002331noevports
2332 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2333 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2334 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2335 also "nopoll".
2336
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002337nogetaddrinfo
2338 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2339 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2340
2341nokqueue
2342 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2343 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2344 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2345
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002346nopoll
2347 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2348 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002349 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002350 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2351 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002352
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002353noreuseport
2354 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2355 command line argument "-dR".
2356
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002357nosplice
2358 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002359 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002360 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002361 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002362 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2363 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2364 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2365 "option splice-response".
2366
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002367profiling.memory { on | off }
2368 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2369 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2370 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2371 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2372 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2373 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2374 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2375 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2376 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2377
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002378profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2379 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2380 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2381 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2382 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002383 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002384 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2385 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2386 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2387 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2388
2389 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2390 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2391 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2392 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2393 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002394 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2395 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2396 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2397 CLI.
2398
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002399spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002400 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2401 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2402 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2403 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2404 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2405 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002406
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002407ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002408 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002409 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002410 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002411 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002412 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2413 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2414 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002415 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2416 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002417 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2418 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2419 openssl configuration file uses:
2420 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2421
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002422ssl-mode-async
2423 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002424 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002425 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2426 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002427 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002428 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002429 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002430
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002431tune.buffers.limit <number>
2432 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2433 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2434 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2435 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2436 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002437 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002438 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2439 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2440 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2441 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2442 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2443 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2444 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2445 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002446 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002447
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002448tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2449 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2450 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2451 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002452 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002453
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002454tune.bufsize <number>
2455 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2456 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2457 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2458 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2459 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2460 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2461 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002462 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2463 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002464 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002465 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002466 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002467 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2468 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002469
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002470tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2471 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002472
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002473tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2474 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2475 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2476 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2477 this value. The default value is 1.
2478
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002479tune.fail-alloc
2480 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2481 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2482 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2483 gracefully.
2484
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002485tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2486 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2487 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2488 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2489 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2490 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2491
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002492tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2493 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2494 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2495 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2496 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2497 change it.
2498
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002499tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2500 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002501 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002502 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002503 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2504 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2505 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2506 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2507 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2508
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002509tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2510 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2511 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2512 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2513 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2514 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002515 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002516 recommended not to change this value.
2517
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002518tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002519 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002520 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002521 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002522 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2523 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2524 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2525 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2526
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002527tune.http.cookielen <number>
2528 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2529 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2530 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2531 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2532 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2533 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2534 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2535 to change this value.
2536
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002537tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002538 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2539 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002540 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002541 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002542 configuration directives too.
2543 The default value is 1024.
2544
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002545tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2546 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2547 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2548 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2549 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2550 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2551 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002552 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2553 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2554 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002555
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002556tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2557 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2558 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2559 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2560 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2561 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2562 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002563 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2564 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2565 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2566 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2567 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002568
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002569tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002570 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002571 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2572 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2573 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2574 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002575 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002576 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002577 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002578 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2579
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002580tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2581 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2582 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2583 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2584 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2585 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2586 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2587 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2588 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2589 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2590
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002591tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2592 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002593 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002594 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2595 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002596 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002597 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2598 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2599
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002600tune.lua.maxmem
2601 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2602 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2603 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2604 memory.
2605
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002606tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2607 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002608 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2609 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002610 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002611
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002612tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2613 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2614 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2615 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002616 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002617
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002618tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2619 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2620 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2621 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2622 check servers.
2623
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002624tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002625 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2626 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002627 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2628 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2629 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2630 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2631 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2632 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2633 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2634 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2635 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002636
2637tune.maxpollevents <number>
2638 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2639 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2640 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2641 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2642 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2643
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002644tune.maxrewrite <number>
2645 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2646 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2647 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2648 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2649 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2650 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2651 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2652 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2653 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2654 bufsize.
2655
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002656tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2657 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2658 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2659 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2660 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2661 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2662 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2663 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2664 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2665 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002666 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2667 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002668 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2669 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2670 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2671 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2672 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2673 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2674 setting this parameter to 0.
2675
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002676tune.pipesize <number>
2677 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2678 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2679 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2680 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2681 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2682 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2683
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002684tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2685 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002686 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002687 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2688 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2689 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2690 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002691 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002692
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002693tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2694 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002695 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002696 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2697 default is 20.
2698
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002699tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2700tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2701 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2702 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2703 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002704 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002705 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002706 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2707 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2708
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002709tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002710 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002711 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2712 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2713 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2714 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2715
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002716tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002717 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002718 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2719 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2720 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2721 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2722 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2723 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2724 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002725
2726tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2727 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002728 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002729 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2730 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2731 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2732 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2733 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2734 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2735 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002736
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002737tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2738tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2739 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2740 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2741 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002742 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002743 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002744 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2745 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2746 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2747 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002748 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002749
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002750tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002751 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002752 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2753 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2754 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2755 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2756 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2757 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2758 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2759 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2760 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2761 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2762 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002763
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002764tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2765 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2766 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2767 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2768 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2769
2770tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2771 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2772 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2773 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2774 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2775 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2776 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2777 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2778 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2779 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2780 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2781 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2782 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2783
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002784tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002785 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002786 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2787 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2788 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2789 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2790 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2791
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002792tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2793 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2794 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2795 performances. This is disabled by default.
2796
2797 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2798 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2799
2800 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2801
2802 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2803
2804 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2805
2806 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2807 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2808 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2809
2810 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2811 converted.
2812
2813 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2814 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2815 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2816 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2817 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2818 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2819 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002820 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2821 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002822
2823 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2824
2825 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2826 only need this line:
2827
2828 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2829
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002830tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2831 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002832 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002833 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2834 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2835 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2836 being used for too long.
2837
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002838tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2839 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2840 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2841 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2842 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2843 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2844 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2845 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2846 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2847 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2848 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002849 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002850 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002851
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002852tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2853 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2854 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2855 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2856 1000 entries.
2857
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002858tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002859tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002860tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2861tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2862tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002863 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2864 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2865 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2866 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2867 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2868 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2869 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2870 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002871
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002872 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2873 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2874 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2875 all available space is consumed.
2876 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2877 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2878 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002879
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002880tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2881 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002882 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002883 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002884 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002885 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2886
2887tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2888 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2889 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002890 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2891 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028933.3. Debugging
2894--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002895
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002896quiet
2897 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2898 line argument "-q".
2899
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002900zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002901 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002902 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2903 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2904 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2905 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2906 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2907
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029093.4. Userlists
2910--------------
2911It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2912http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2913it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2914
2915userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002916 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2918
2919group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002920 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002921 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2922 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2923
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002924user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2925 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002926 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2927 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002928 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2929 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2930 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2931 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002932
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002933 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2934 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2935 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2936 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2937 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2938 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2939 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002940 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002941 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002942
2943 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002944 userlist L1
2945 group G1 users tiger,scott
2946 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002948 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2949 user scott insecure-password elgato
2950 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002952 userlist L2
2953 group G1
2954 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002955
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002956 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2957 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2958 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002959
2960 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002961
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002962
29633.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002964----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002965It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002966several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002967instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2968values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2969automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2970In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2971using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2972tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2973reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2974Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2975that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2976each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002977
2978peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002979 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002980 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2981
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002982bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2983 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2984 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2985
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002986disabled
2987 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2988 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2989 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2990
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002991default-bind [param*]
2992 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2993
2994default-server [param*]
2995 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2996
2997 Arguments:
2998 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2999 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003000 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3001 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3002 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3003 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003004
3005 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3006
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003007enabled
3008 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3009 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003010
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003011log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003012 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3013 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3014 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3015 more details.
3016
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003017peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003018 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3019 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003020 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003021 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003022 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3023 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3024 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003025
3026 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3027 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3028
3029 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003030 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3031 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3032 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003033
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003034 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3035 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003036
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003037 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3038 "server" keyword explanation below).
3039
3040server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003041 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003042 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3043 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3044 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3045 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003046
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003047 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3048 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3049 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3050 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3051 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003052
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003053 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003054 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003056 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3057 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3058 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003059
3060 backend mybackend
3061 mode tcp
3062 balance roundrobin
3063 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3064 stick on src
3065
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003066 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3067 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003068
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003069 Example:
3070 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003071 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3072 default-server ssl verify none
3073 server haproxy1 #local peer
3074 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3075 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003076
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003077
3078table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3079 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3080
3081 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3082 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003083 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003084 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3085 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3086 "stick-table" keyword).
3087
3088 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3089 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3090 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3091 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3092 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3093 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3094 of the stick-table name as follows:
3095
3096 peers mypeers
3097 peer A ...
3098 peer B ...
3099 table t1 ...
3100
3101 frontend fe1
3102 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3103
3104 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3105 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3106
3107 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3108 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3109 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3110 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3111 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3112 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3113 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3114
3115 peers mypeers
3116 peer A ...
3117 peer B ...
3118 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3119
3120 backend t1
3121 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3122
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003123 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003124 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3125 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3126
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031273.6. Mailers
3128------------
3129It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3130If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3131in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3132
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003133mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003134 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3135 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3136
3137mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3138 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3139
3140 Example:
3141 mailers mymailers
3142 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3143 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3144
3145 backend mybackend
3146 mode tcp
3147 balance roundrobin
3148
3149 email-alert mailers mymailers
3150 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3151 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3152
3153 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3154 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3155
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003156timeout mail <time>
3157 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3158 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3159 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3160 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3161
3162 Example:
3163 mailers mymailers
3164 timeout mail 20s
3165 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003166
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031673.7. Programs
3168-------------
3169In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3170master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3171managed the same way as the workers.
3172
3173During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3174sequence as a worker:
3175
3176 - the master is re-executed
3177 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3178 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3179 instance of the program
3180
3181During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3182
3183program <name>
3184 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3185 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3186 the management guide).
3187
3188command <command> [arguments*]
3189 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3190 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3191 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3192 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3193
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003194user <user name>
3195 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3196 See also "group".
3197
3198group <group name>
3199 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3200 See also "user".
3201
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003202option start-on-reload
3203no option start-on-reload
3204 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3205 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3206 program section.
3207
3208
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032093.8. HTTP-errors
3210----------------
3211
3212It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3213imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3214several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3215
3216http-errors <name>
3217 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3218 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3219
3220errorfile <code> <file>
3221 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3222
3223 Arguments :
3224 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003225 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003226 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003227
3228 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3229 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3230 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3231 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3232 before any chroot is performed.
3233
3234 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3235
3236 Example:
3237 http-errors website-1
3238 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3239 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3240 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3241
3242 http-errors website-2
3243 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3244 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3245 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3246
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032473.9. Rings
3248----------
3249
3250It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3251servers or traces.
3252
3253ring <ringname>
3254 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3255
3256description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003257 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003258 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3259
3260format <format>
3261 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3262
3263 Arguments:
3264 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3265 one of the following :
3266
3267 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3268 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3269 designed to be used with a local log server.
3270
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003271 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3272 field is stripped. This is the default.
3273 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3274 rfc3164.
3275
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003276 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3277 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3278 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3279 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3280 is the default.
3281
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003282 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003283 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3284
3285 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3286 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3287
3288 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3289 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3290 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3291 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3292 logger consumes.
3293
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003294 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3295 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3296 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3297 with a local log server.
3298
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003299 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3300 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3301 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3302 used with a local log server.
3303
3304maxlen <length>
3305 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3306 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3307 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3308
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003309server <name> <address> [param*]
3310 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3311 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3312 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3313 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3314 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3315 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3316 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3317 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3318 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003319 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3320 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003321
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003322size <size>
3323 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3324 set to BUFSIZE.
3325
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003326timeout connect <timeout>
3327 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3328
3329 Arguments :
3330 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3331 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3332 as explained at the top of this document.
3333
3334timeout server <timeout>
3335 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3336
3337 Arguments :
3338 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3339 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3340 as explained at the top of this document.
3341
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003342 Example:
3343 global
3344 log ring@myring local7
3345
3346 ring myring
3347 description "My local buffer"
3348 format rfc3164
3349 maxlen 1200
3350 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003351 timeout connect 5s
3352 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003353 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003354
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033553.10. Log forwarding
3356-------------------
3357
3358It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003359HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003360
3361log-forward <name>
3362 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3363
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003364backlog <conns>
3365 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3366 on connections accept.
3367
3368bind <addr> [param*]
3369 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003370 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3371 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3372 syslog protocol over TCP.
3373 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003374 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3375
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003376dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003377 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3378 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3379 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3380 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003381 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003382
3383log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003384log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003385 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3386 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3387 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003388 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003389 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3390 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3391 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003392 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003393
3394 Example:
3395 global
3396 log stderr format iso local7
3397
3398 ring myring
3399 description "My local buffer"
3400 format rfc5424
3401 maxlen 1200
3402 size 32764
3403 timeout connect 5s
3404 timeout server 10s
3405 # syslog tcp server
3406 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3407
3408 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003409 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3410 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003411 # all messages on stderr
3412 log global
3413 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3414 log ring@myring local0
3415 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3416 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3417 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3418 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3419 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003420
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003421maxconn <conns>
3422 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3423 10 is the default.
3424
3425timeout client <timeout>
3426 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034284. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003429----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003431Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003432 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3433 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3434 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3435 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003436
3437A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3438connections.
3439
3440A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3441to forward incoming connections.
3442
3443A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3444parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3445
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003446A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3447ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3448sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3449the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3450explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3451from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3452"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3453for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3454to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3455optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3456are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3457any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3458names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3459that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3460duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3461names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3462
3463Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3464settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3465of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3466profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3467timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3470'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3471case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3472
3473Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3474logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3475proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3476However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3477name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3478
3479Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3480and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003481bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3483modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3484arbitrary criteria.
3485
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003486In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3487a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003488the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003489
3490 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3491 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3492 between responses and new requests.
3493
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003494 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3495 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3496 client-facing connection remains open.
3497
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003498 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3499 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003500
3501The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3502frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3503following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003504weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003505
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003506 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003507
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003508 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3509 ----+-----+-----+----
3510 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3511 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003512 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3513 ----+-----+-----+----
3514 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003515
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003516It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003517only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3518within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003519as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003520content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003521and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3522possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003524There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003525first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003526processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003527second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003528protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3529is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3530new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003531to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003532process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3533already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3534HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3535evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3536one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3537
3538There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3539performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3540tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3541preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3542analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3543HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3544header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3545mitigate this drawback.
3546
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003547There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003548method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3549set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3550in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3551is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3552to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3553above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3554to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3555"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3556frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3557frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3558as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3559upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3560on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3561the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3562upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3563frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3564remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035664.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3567--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003569The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3570limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3571they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3572limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003573marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003574option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003575and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3576with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3577specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003579
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003580 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3581------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3582acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583backlog X X X -
3584balance X - X X
3585bind - X X -
3586bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003587capture cookie - X X -
3588capture request header - X X -
3589capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003590clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3591clitcpka-idle X X X -
3592clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003593compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003595declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596default-server X - X X
3597default_backend X X X -
3598description - X X X
3599disabled X X X X
3600dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003601email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003602email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003603email-alert mailers X X X X
3604email-alert myhostname X X X X
3605email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606enabled X X X X
3607errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003608errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003609errorloc X X X X
3610errorloc302 X X X X
3611-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3612errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003613force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003614filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003615fullconn X - X X
3616grace X X X X
3617hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003618http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003619http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003620http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003621http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003622http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003623http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003624http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003625http-check set-var X - X X
3626http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003627http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003629http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003630http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003631http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003632id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003633ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003634load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003635log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003636log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003637log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003638log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003639max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640maxconn X X X -
3641mode X X X X
3642monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643monitor-uri X X X -
3644option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3645option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3646option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3647option allbackups (*) X - X X
3648option checkcache (*) X - X X
3649option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3650option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003651option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003652option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3653option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3655option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003656option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3657option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003658option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003659option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003660option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003661option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003662option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003663option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003664option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3665option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3666option httpchk X - X X
3667option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003668option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003670option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003671option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003672option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003673option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3674option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3675option logasap (*) X X X -
3676option mysql-check X - X X
3677option nolinger (*) X X X X
3678option originalto X X X X
3679option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003680option pgsql-check X - X X
3681option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003682option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003683option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003684option smtpchk X - X X
3685option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3686option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3687option splice-request (*) X X X X
3688option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003689option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3691option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3692-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003693option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003694option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3695option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3696option tcpka X X X X
3697option tcplog X X X X
3698option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003699option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003700external-check command X - X X
3701external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3703rate-limit sessions X X X -
3704redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003707retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003708server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003709server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003710server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003711source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003712srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3713srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3714srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003715stats admin - X X X
3716stats auth X X X X
3717stats enable X X X X
3718stats hide-version X X X X
3719stats http-request - X X X
3720stats realm X X X X
3721stats refresh X X X X
3722stats scope X X X X
3723stats show-desc X X X X
3724stats show-legends X X X X
3725stats show-node X X X X
3726stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003727-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3728stick match - - X X
3729stick on - - X X
3730stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003731stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003732stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003733tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003734tcp-check connect X - X X
3735tcp-check expect X - X X
3736tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003737tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003738tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003739tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003740tcp-check set-var X - X X
3741tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003742tcp-request connection - X X -
3743tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003744tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003745tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003746tcp-response content - - X X
3747tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003748timeout check X - X X
3749timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003750timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003751timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003752timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3753timeout http-request X X X X
3754timeout queue X - X X
3755timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003756timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003757timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003758timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003759transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003760unique-id-format X X X -
3761unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003762use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003763use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003764use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003765------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3766 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037694.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3770---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003771
3772This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3773
3774
3775acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3776 Declare or complete an access list.
3777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 no | yes | yes | yes
3779 Example:
3780 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3781 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3782 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003784 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003785
3786
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003787backlog <conns>
3788 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | no
3791 Arguments :
3792 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3793 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003794 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003795
3796 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3797 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3798 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3799 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3800 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3801 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3802 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3803 backlog parameter.
3804
3805 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3806 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3807 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3808
3809 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3810
3811
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003812balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003813balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003814 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3816 yes | no | yes | yes
3817 Arguments :
3818 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3819 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3820 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3821 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3822
3823 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3824 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3825 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3826 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003827 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003828 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003829 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3830 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3831 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3832 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3833 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3834 it, so that you don't worry.
3835
3836 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3837 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3838 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3839 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3840 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3841 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3842 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3843 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003844
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003845 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3846 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3847 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3848 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3849 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3850 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3851 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003852 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3853 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3854 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003855
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003856 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003857 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003858 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3859 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003860 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003861 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3862 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3863 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3864 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3865 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003866 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3867 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3868 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3869 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3870 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3871 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003872
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003873 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3874 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3875 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3876 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3877 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3878 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3879 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3880 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003881 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003883 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3884 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3885 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003886
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003887 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3888 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3889 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3890 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3891 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3892 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3893 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3894 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3895 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3896 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3897 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3898 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003899
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003900 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003901 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3902 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3903 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3904 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3905 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3906 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3907 URIs start with a leading "/".
3908
3909 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3910 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3911 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3912 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3913
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003914 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3915 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3916 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3917 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003920 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3921
3922 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003923 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3924 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003925 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3926 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3927 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3928 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003929 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003930 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3931 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003932
3933 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3934 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3935 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3936 server will receive the request.
3937
3938 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3939 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3940 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3941 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3942 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003943 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3944 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3945 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003947 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3948 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3949 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3950 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3951 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003953 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003954 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3955 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3956 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3957
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003958 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3959 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3960 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3961
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003962 random
3963 random(<draws>)
3964 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003965 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3966 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3967 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3968 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003969 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3970 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3971 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3972 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3973 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3974 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3975 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3976 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3977 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3978 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3979 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3980 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3981 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3982 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3983 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3984 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3985 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3986 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3987 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3988 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003989
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003990 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003991 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003992 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3993 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003994 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003995 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3996 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3997 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003998 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003999 used instead.
4000
4001 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4002 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4003 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004004 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004005
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004006 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4007 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4008 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4009
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004010 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004011 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4012 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004013
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004014 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4015 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4016 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004017
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004018 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004019 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004020 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4021 NTLM relies on.
4022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004023 Examples :
4024 balance roundrobin
4025 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004027 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4028 balance hdr(host)
4029 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004030
4031 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4032 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004034 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004035 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4036 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4037 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004038 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004039
4040 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4041 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4042 defaults to 16 kB.
4043
4044 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4045 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4046
4047 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4048 Round Robin.
4049
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004050 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004051 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4052 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4053 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4054
4055 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4056
4057 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004058 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004059 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4060 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4061 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004062
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004063 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004064
4065
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004066bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4067bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004068 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 no | yes | yes | no
4071 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004072 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4073 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4074 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4075 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004076 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004077 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4078 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4079 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4080 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4081 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4082 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004083 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004084 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4085 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004086 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004087 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4088 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004089 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004090 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4091 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004092 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004093 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4094 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4095 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4096 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4097 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4098 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4099 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004100 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4101 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4102 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004103 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4104 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4105 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4106 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004107 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4108 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4109 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004110
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004111 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4112 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004113 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4114 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4115 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004116 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4117 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4118 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4119 the range.
4120
4121 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4122 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4123 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4124 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4125 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4126 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4127 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004128 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004129 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004131 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004132 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004133 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4134 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4135 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4136 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4137 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4138 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4139
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004140 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4141 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4142 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4143 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004145 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4146 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4147 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4148 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4149 in a frontend.
4150
4151 Example :
4152 listen http_proxy
4153 bind :80,:443
4154 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004155 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004156
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004157 listen http_https_proxy
4158 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004159 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004160
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004161 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4162 bind ipv6@:80
4163 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4164 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4165
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004166 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004167 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004168
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004169 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4170 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4171 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4172 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4173 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4174
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004175 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004176 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004177
4178
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004179bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004180 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4182 yes | yes | yes | yes
4183 Arguments :
4184 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4185 may be used to override a default value.
4186
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004187 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004188 option may be combined with other numbers.
4189
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004190 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004191 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4192 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4193 missing from all processes.
4194
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004195 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004196 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004197 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4198 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4199 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4200 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4201 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004202 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004203
4204 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4205 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4206 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4207 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4208 and 'even' instances.
4209
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004210 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4211 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4212 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4213 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004214
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004215 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4216 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4217
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004218 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4219 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4220 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4221
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004222 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4223 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4224
4225 Example :
4226 listen app_ip1
4227 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004228 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004229
4230 listen app_ip2
4231 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004232 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004233
4234 listen management
4235 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004236 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004237
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004238 listen management
4239 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4240 bind-process 1-4
4241
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004242 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004243
4244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004245capture cookie <name> len <length>
4246 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 no | yes | yes | no
4249 Arguments :
4250 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4251 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4252 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4253 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004254 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004255
4256 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4257 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4258 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4259 right if it exceeds <length>.
4260
4261 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4262 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4263 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4264 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4265
4266 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4267 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4268 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4269
4270 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4271 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4272 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004273 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4274 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4275 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004276
4277 Example:
4278 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4279
4280 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004281 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282
4283
4284capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004285 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4287 no | yes | yes | no
4288 Arguments :
4289 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004290 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4292 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4293 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4294
4295 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4296 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4297 it exceeds <length>.
4298
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004299 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004300 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4301 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004302 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4303 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4304 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4305 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004306 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004307 environments to find where the request came from.
4308
4309 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4310 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4311 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4312 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004313
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004314 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4315 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4316 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4317 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4318 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004319
4320 Example:
4321 capture request header Host len 15
4322 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004323 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004325 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004326 about logging.
4327
4328
4329capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004330 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4332 no | yes | yes | no
4333 Arguments :
4334 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004335 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4337 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4338 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4339
4340 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4341 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4342 it exceeds <length>.
4343
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004344 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4346 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4347 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004348 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4349 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4350 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4351 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004352
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004353 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4354 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4355 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4356 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4357 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004358
4359 Example:
4360 capture response header Content-length len 9
4361 capture response header Location len 15
4362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004364 about logging.
4365
4366
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004367clitcpka-cnt <count>
4368 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4369 the connection on the client side.
4370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4371 yes | yes | yes | no
4372 Arguments :
4373 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4374
4375 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4376 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004377 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4378 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004379
4380 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4381
4382
4383clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4384 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4385 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4386 client side.
4387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4388 yes | yes | yes | no
4389 Arguments :
4390 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4391 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4392 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4393 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4394
4395 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4396 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004397 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4398 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004399
4400 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4401
4402
4403clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4404 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4406 yes | yes | yes | no
4407 Arguments :
4408 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4409 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4410 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4411 document.
4412
4413 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4414 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004415 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4416 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004417
4418 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4419
4420
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004421compression algo <algorithm> ...
4422compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004423compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004424 Enable HTTP compression.
4425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4426 yes | yes | yes | yes
4427 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004428 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4429 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004430 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004431
4432 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004433 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4434 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4435 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004436
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004437 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004438 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004439
4440 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4441 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4442 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4443 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4444 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004445 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004446
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004447 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4448 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4449 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4450 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4451 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4452 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4453 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004454 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004455
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004456 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004457 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004458 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004459 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004460 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004461 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004462 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004463
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004464 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004465 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4466 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004467 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4468 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004469 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004470 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004471 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4472 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004473 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004474 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4475 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004476
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004477 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004478 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4479 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004480 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004481 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004482 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4483 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4484 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4485 "multipart"
4486 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4487 header
4488 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4489 and later
4490 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4491 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004492 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004493
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004494 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004495
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004496 Examples :
4497 compression algo gzip
4498 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004499
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004500
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004501cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004502 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4503 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004504 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 yes | no | yes | yes
4508 Arguments :
4509 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4510 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4511 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4512 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4513 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4514 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004515 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004516 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4517 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4518
4519 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004520 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004521 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4522 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4523 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4524 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004525 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4526 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004527 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004528 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4529 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004530
4531 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004532 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004533
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004534 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004535 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004536 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004537 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004538 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4539 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4540 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4541 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4542 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4543 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4544 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004545
4546 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4547 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4548 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4549 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4550 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4551 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4552 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4553 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4554 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004555 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004556 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4557 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4558 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004559
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004560 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4561 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4562 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004563 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4564 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4565 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4566 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004567 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4568 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4569 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004570
4571 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4572 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4573 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4574 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4575 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4576 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4577 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4578 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4579 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4580
4581 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4582 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4583 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4584 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4585 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4586 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4587 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4588 persistence cookie in the cache.
4589 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4590
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004591 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4592 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004593 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004594 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4595 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004596 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004597 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4598 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4599 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4600 they logout.
4601
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004602 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004603 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4604 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4605 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4606
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004607 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004608 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4609 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4610 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4611 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4612 this attribute.
4613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004614 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004615 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004616 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4617 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4618 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4619 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4620 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4621 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004622
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004623 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4624 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4625 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4626 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4627 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4628 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4629 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4630 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004631 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004632 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4633 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4634 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4635 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4636 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4637 the site.
4638
4639 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4640 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4641 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4642 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4643 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4644 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4645 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4646 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4647 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4648 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4649 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4650 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4651 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004652 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004653 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4654 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4655
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004656 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4657 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4658 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4659 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4660 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4661 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4662
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004663 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004664 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4665 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4666 repeated.
4667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004668 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4669 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4670 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4671 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004673 Examples :
4674 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4675 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4676 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004677 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004678
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004679 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004680
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004681
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004682declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4683 Declares a capture slot.
4684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4685 no | yes | yes | no
4686 Arguments:
4687 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4688
4689 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4690 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4691 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4692 for use in the response.
4693
4694 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004695 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004696 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4697
4698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004699default-server [param*]
4700 Change default options for a server in a backend
4701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4702 yes | no | yes | yes
4703 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004704 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4705 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4706 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4707 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004708
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004709 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004710 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4711
4712 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004713
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004714
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004715default_backend <backend>
4716 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4718 yes | yes | yes | no
4719 Arguments :
4720 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4721
4722 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4723 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4724 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4725 will catch all undetermined requests.
4726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004727 Example :
4728
4729 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4730 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4731 default_backend dynamic
4732
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004733 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004735
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004736description <string>
4737 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4739 no | yes | yes | yes
4740 Arguments : string
4741
4742 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4743 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4744 it describes.
4745 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4746
4747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004748disabled
4749 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | yes | yes | yes
4752 Arguments : none
4753
4754 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4755 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4756 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4757 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4758 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4759 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4760 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4761
4762 See also : "enabled"
4763
4764
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004765dispatch <address>:<port>
4766 Set a default server address
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4768 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004769 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004770
4771 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4772 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4773 during start-up.
4774
4775 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4776 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4777 possible with normal servers.
4778
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004779 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004780 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4781 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4782 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4783 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4784
4785 See also : "server"
4786
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004787
4788dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4789 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4791 yes | no | yes | yes
4792 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4793
4794 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004795 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004796 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4797 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004798 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004799 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004800
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004801enabled
4802 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4804 yes | yes | yes | yes
4805 Arguments : none
4806
4807 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4808 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4809
4810 See also : "disabled"
4811
4812
4813errorfile <code> <file>
4814 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 yes | yes | yes | yes
4817 Arguments :
4818 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004819 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004820 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004821
4822 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004823 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004824 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004825 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4826 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004827
4828 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4829 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4830 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4831
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004832 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4833
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004834 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4835 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4836 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4837 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4838 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4839 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4840 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4841 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4842 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4845 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4846 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004847 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004848 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4849
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004850 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004851
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004852 Example :
4853 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004854 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004855 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4856 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4857
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004858
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004859errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4860 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4861 section.
4862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 yes | yes | yes | yes
4864 Arguments :
4865 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4866
4867 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004868 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004869 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4870 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004871
4872 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4873 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4874 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4875 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4876 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004877 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004878 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4879
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004880 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4881 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004882
4883 Example :
4884 errorfiles generic
4885 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4886
4887
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004888errorloc <code> <url>
4889errorloc302 <code> <url>
4890 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 yes | yes | yes | yes
4893 Arguments :
4894 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004895 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004896 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004897
4898 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4899 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4900 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4901 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004902 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004903
4904 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4905 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4906 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4907
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004908 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4911 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4912 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4913 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004914 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004915 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4916 request.
4917
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004918 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919
4920
4921errorloc303 <code> <url>
4922 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4924 yes | yes | yes | yes
4925 Arguments :
4926 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004927 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004928 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004929
4930 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4931 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4932 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4933 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004934 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004935
4936 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4937 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4938 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4939
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004940 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4941
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4943 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4944 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4945 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004946 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004947
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004948 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004949
4950
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004951email-alert from <emailaddr>
4952 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004953 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | yes | yes | yes
4956
4957 Arguments :
4958
4959 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4960
4961 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4962 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4963
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004964 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004965 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4966 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004967
4968
4969email-alert level <level>
4970 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4971 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4973 yes | yes | yes | yes
4974
4975 Arguments :
4976
4977 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4978 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4979 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4980
4981 By default level is alert
4982
4983 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4984 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4985 for the proxy.
4986
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004987 Alerts are sent when :
4988
4989 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4990 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4991 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4992 is notice or lower
4993 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4994 and a health check status update occurs
4995
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004996 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4997 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004998 section 3.6 about mailers.
4999
5000
5001email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5002 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5004 yes | yes | yes | yes
5005
5006 Arguments :
5007
5008 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5009
5010 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5011 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5012
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005013 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5014 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005015
5016
5017email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5018 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5019 mailers.
5020 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5021 yes | yes | yes | yes
5022
5023 Arguments :
5024
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005025 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005026
5027 By default the systems hostname is used.
5028
5029 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5030 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5031 for the proxy.
5032
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005033 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5034 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005035
5036
5037email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005038 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005039 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5041 yes | yes | yes | yes
5042
5043 Arguments :
5044
5045 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5046
5047 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5048 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5049
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005050 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005051 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5052
5053
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005054force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5055 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005057 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005058
5059 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5060 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5061 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5062 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5063 marked down for maintenance operations.
5064
5065 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5066 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5067 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5068 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5069 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5070 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5071 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5072 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5073 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5074
5075 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5076 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5077 is used.
5078
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005079 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005080 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005081
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005082
5083filter <name> [param*]
5084 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5086 no | yes | yes | yes
5087 Arguments :
5088 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5089 referenced in section 9.
5090
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005091 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005092 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005093 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5094 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005095
5096 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5097 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5098
5099 Example:
5100 listen
5101 bind *:80
5102
5103 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5104 filter compression
5105 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5106
5107 compression algo gzip
5108 compression offload
5109
5110 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5111
5112 See also : section 9.
5113
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005114
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005115fullconn <conns>
5116 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5118 yes | no | yes | yes
5119 Arguments :
5120 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5121 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5122
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005123 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005124 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005125 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005126 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5127 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5128 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5129 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5130 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005131 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005132
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005133 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005134 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005135 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5136 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5137 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005138
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005139 Example :
5140 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5141 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5142 # connections.
5143 backend dynamic
5144 fullconn 10000
5145 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5146 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5147
5148 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5149
5150
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005151grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005152 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005154 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005155 Arguments :
5156 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5157 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5158 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5159
5160 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5161 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005162 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005163 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5164
5165 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5166 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5167 simplify it.
5168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005169
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005170hash-balance-factor <factor>
5171 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5173 yes | no | no | yes
5174 Arguments :
5175 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5176 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005177 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005178
5179 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5180 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5181 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5182 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5183 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5184 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5185 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5186
5187 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5188 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5189 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5190 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5191 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5192
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005193 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5194 consistent hashing mechanism.
5195
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005196 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5197
5198
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005199hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005200 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5202 yes | no | yes | yes
5203 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005204 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5205 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005206
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005207 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5208 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5209 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5210 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5211 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5212 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5213 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5214 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5215 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5216 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005217
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005218 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5219 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5220 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5221 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5222 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5223 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5224 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5225 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5226 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5227 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5228 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5229 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5230 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005231 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5232 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005233
5234 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5235
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005236 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005237 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5238 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5239 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005240 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5241 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5242 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005243
5244 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5245 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005246 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5247 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5248 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5249 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5250
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005251 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005252 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5253 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5254 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5255 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5256 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5257 parameter.
5258
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005259 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5260 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5261 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5262 used on strings.
5263
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005264 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5265
5266 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5267 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5268 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5269 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5270 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5271 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5272 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5273 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5274 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5275 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5276 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5277 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005278
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005279 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5280 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5281 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005282
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005283 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005284
5285
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005286http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5287 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5288 ones).
5289
5290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5291 no | yes | yes | yes
5292
5293 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5294 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5295 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5296 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5297 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5298 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5299
5300 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5301 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5302 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5303
5304 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5305 below.
5306
5307 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5308 instance.
5309
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005310 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5311 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5312 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5313
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005314 Example:
5315 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5316 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5317 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5318
5319http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5320
5321 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5322 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5323 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5324 example, or to pass some internal information.
5325 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5326 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5327 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5328
5329http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330
5331 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5332 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5333
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005334http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005335
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005336 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5337 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5338 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5339 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5340 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005341
5342http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5343 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5344
5345 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5346
5347 Example:
5348 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5349
5350 # applied to:
5351 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5352
5353 # outputs:
5354 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5355
5356 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5357
5358http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5359 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5360
5361 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5362
5363 Example:
5364 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5365
5366 # applied to:
5367 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5368
5369 # outputs:
5370 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5371
5372http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5373
5374 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5375 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5376 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5377
5378http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5379 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5380
5381 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5382 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5383 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5384 fallback.
5385
5386 Example:
5387 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5388 http-response set-status 431
5389 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5390 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5391
5392http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5393
5394 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5395 inline.
5396
5397 Arguments:
5398 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5399 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5400 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5401 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5402 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5403 (request and response)
5404 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5405 processing
5406 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5407 processing
5408 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5409 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5410 and '_'.
5411
5412 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5413 followed by some converters.
5414
5415 Example:
5416 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5417
5418http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5419
5420 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5421 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5422 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5423 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5424 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005425 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005426 processing.
5427
5428 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5429 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005430 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005431 rules evaluation.
5432
5433http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5434
5435 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5436 details about <var-name>.
5437
5438 Example:
5439 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5440
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005441
5442http-check comment <string>
5443 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5444 it fails.
5445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5446 yes | no | yes | yes
5447
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005448 Arguments :
5449 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5450 rule fails.
5451
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005452 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5453 user-friendly error reporting.
5454
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005455 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005456 "http-check expect".
5457
5458
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005459http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5460 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005461 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005462 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 yes | no | yes | yes
5465
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005466 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005467 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5468
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005469 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005470 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471
5472 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5473 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5474 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5475 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5476
5477 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5478
5479 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5480
5481 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5482
5483 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5484
5485 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5486
5487 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5488 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5489 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5490 is used.
5491
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005492 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5493 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5494 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5495 haproxy -vv.
5496
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005497 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5498
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005499 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5500 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5501 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5502 different ports or with different servers.
5503
5504 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5505 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5506 the port with a "http-check connect".
5507
5508 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5509 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5510 do.
5511
5512 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5513 unset-var or comment rules.
5514
5515 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005516 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5517 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5518 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5519 option httpchk
5520
5521 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005522 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005523 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005524 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005525 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005526 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005527
5528 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5529
5530 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005531
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533http-check disable-on-404
5534 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005536 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005537 Arguments : none
5538
5539 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5540 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5541 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5542 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5543 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5544 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5545 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5546 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005547 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5548 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005549 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5550 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5551 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005552
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005553 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005554
5555
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005556http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005557 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5558 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5559 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005560 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005562 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005563
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005564 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005565 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5566
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005567 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5568 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5569 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5570 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5571 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5572 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5573 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5574 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5575 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5576 result is always conclusive.
5577
5578 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5579 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5580 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005581 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5582 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005583 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5584 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005585 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5586 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5587 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005588
5589 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5590 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005591 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5592 supported :
5593 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5594 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005595 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5596 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5597 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5598 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5599 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005600
5601 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5602 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005603 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5604 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5605 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5606 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005607 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5608
5609 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5610 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5611 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5612 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5613
5614 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5615 informational message reported in logs if an error
5616 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5617 log-format string.
5618
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005619 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005620 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5621 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005622 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5623 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5624 details on the supported keywords.
5625
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005626 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5627 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5628 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5629 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005630
5631 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5632 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5633 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5634 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5635 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5636
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005637 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5638 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5639 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5640 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5641 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5642 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5643 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005644
5645 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005646 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005647 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5648 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5649 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5650 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5651
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005652 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5653 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005654 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5655 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5656 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5657 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5658 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5659 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5660 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5661 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005662 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5663 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5664 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5665 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5666 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5667 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5668 insensitive on the header names.
5669
5670 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5671 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5672 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5673 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5674 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5675 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005676
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005677 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005678 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005679 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5680 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5681 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5682 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5683 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005684 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685 trace).
5686
5687 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005688 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005689 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5690 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5691 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5692 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5693 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005694 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005695
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005696 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5697 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5698 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5699 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5700 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5701 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5702
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005703 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005704 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005705 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5706 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5707 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5708 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5709 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5710 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5711
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005712 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5713 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5714 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5715 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5716 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005717
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5719 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5720
5721 Examples :
5722 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005723 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005725 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5726 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5727
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005728 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005729 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005730
5731 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005732 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005733
5734 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005735 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005736
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005737 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005738 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005739
5740
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005741http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005742 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5743 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005744 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5745 health checks.
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | no | yes | yes
5748 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005749 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5750
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005751 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5752 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5753 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5754 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5755 to invent non-standard ones.
5756
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005757 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5758 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5759 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5760 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5761
5762 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5763 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5764 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5765 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005766
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005767 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005768 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005769 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005770 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5771 to add it.
5772
5773 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5774 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5775 to the log-format rules.
5776
5777 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5778 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5779 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005780
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005781 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5782 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5783 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5784 request.
5785
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005786 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5787 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5788 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005789 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5790 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5791 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5792 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005793 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005794
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005795 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005796 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5797 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005798
5799 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5800 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5801 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5802 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5803 configured request authority.
5804
5805 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5806 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005807
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005808 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005809
5810
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005811http-check send-state
5812 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 yes | no | yes | yes
5815 Arguments : none
5816
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005817 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005818 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005819 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5820 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5821 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005822
5823 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5824 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5825 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5826 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5827 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005828 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5829 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5830 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5831
5832 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5833 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5834 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5835
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005836 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5837 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5838 checked in multiple backends.
5839
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005840 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005841 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5842
5843 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5844 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5845 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5846 one fails.
5847
5848 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5849 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5850 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5851
5852 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5853 server's queue.
5854
5855 Example of a header received by the application server :
5856 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5857 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5858
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005859 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5860 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005861
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005862
5863http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005864 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5866 yes | no | yes | yes
5867
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005868 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005869 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5870 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5871 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5872 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5873 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5874 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5875 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5876 and '-'.
5877
5878 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5879
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005880 Examples :
5881 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882
5883
5884http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005885 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | no | yes | yes
5888
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005889 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005890 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5891 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5892 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5893 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5894 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5895 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5896 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5897 and '-'.
5898
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005899 Examples :
5900 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005902
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005903http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5904 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5905 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5906 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5907 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5909 yes | yes | yes | yes
5910 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005911 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005912 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005913 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005914 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005915
5916 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5917 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5918 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5919 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5920
5921 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5922 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5923 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5924 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5925
5926 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5927 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5928 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5929 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5930 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5931 chroot is performed.
5932
5933 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5934 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5935 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5936 considered.
5937
5938 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5939 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5940 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5941 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5942 considered as a raw string.
5943
5944 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5945 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5946 "content-type".
5947
5948 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5949 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5950 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5951 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5952 evaluated as a log-format string.
5953
5954 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5955 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5956 argument to "content-type".
5957
5958 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5959 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5960 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5961 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5962
5963 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5964 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5965 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5966 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5967 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5968 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5969 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5970 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5971
5972 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5973 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5974 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5975
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005976 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5977 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5978 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5979 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5980 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5981
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005982 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5983 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5984
5985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005986http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005987 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5988
5989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5990 no | yes | yes | yes
5991
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005992 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5993 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5994 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5995 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5996 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005998 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5999 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006001 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003 Example:
6004 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6005 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6006 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008 http-request allow if nagios
6009 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6010 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6011 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 Example:
6014 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6015 acl add path /addacl
6016 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6021 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023 Example:
6024 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6025 acl setmap path /setmap
6026 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006028 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6031 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006033 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6034 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006036http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6039 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6040 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6041 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6042 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6043 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6044 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6045 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006047http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6050 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6051 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6052 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6053 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6054 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6055 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6056 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6061 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006062
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006064http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006066 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6067 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6068 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6069 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6070 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006071
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006072 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6073 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6074 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6075 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6076 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6077 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6078 instead.
6079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006080 Example:
6081 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6082 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006083
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006084http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006085
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006086 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6089 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6092 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6093 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6094 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6095 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6096 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6097 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6098 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6099 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6102 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6103 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006104 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6105
6106 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6107 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6108 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6109 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6114 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6115 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6116 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6117 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6118 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006119
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006120http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006121
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006122 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6123 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6124 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6125 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6126 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006128http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006130 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6131 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6132 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6133 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6134 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6135 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006136
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006137http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6138http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6139 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6140 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6141 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6142 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006143
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006144 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6145 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6146 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006147 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006148 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6149 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6150 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006152 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006153
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006154http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6155 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6156 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6157 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6158
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006159http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6160
6161 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6162 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6163 pointed by <resolvers>.
6164 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6165 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6166 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6167 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6168 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6169 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6170 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6171 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6172 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6173 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006174 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6175 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006176
6177 Example:
6178 resolvers mydns
6179 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6180 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6181 timeout retry 1s
6182 hold valid 10s
6183 hold nx 3s
6184 hold other 3s
6185 hold obsolete 0s
6186 accepted_payload_size 8192
6187
6188 frontend fe
6189 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006190 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006191 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6192
6193 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6194 # which mean DNS resolution error
6195 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6196
6197 default_backend be
6198
6199 backend b_503
6200 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6201 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6202 # 503 error page to end users
6203
6204 backend be
6205 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6206 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6207 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6208 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6209 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6210
6211 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6212 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6213
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006214http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6215
6216 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6217 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6218 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6219 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006220 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6221 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006222
6223 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6224
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006225http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006226http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006227http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006228http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006229http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006230http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006231http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006232http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6233http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006234
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006235 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6236
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006237 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006238 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6239 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6240 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6241 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006242
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006243 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6244 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6245 the supported backend.
6246
6247 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6248 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6249 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6250 number of segments in the path.
6251
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006252 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6253 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6254 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6255 when improperly combined.
6256
6257 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6258 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6259 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6260 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6261 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6262
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006263 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006264
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006265 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6266
6267 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6268 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6269
6270 Example:
6271 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6272
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006273 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6274
6275 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6276 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6277
6278 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6279 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6280
6281 Example:
6282 - /#foo -> /
6283
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006284 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6285 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006286
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006287 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6288 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6289
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006290 Example:
6291 - /. -> /
6292 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6293 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6294 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006295
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006296 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6297 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6298
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006299 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006300 their preceding segment.
6301
6302 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6303 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6304
6305 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6306 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006307
6308 Example:
6309 - /foo/../ -> /
6310 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6311 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6312 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006313 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006314 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006315 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006316
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006317 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6318 removed as well:
6319
6320 Example:
6321 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6322 - /bar/../../ -> /
6323
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006324 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6325 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006326
6327 Example:
6328 - // -> /
6329 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6330
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006331 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6332 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6333
6334 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6335 ".", "_", and "~".
6336
6337 Example:
6338 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6339 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6340 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6341 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6342
6343 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6344 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6345
6346 Example:
6347 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6348 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6349
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006350 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006351 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006352
6353 Example:
6354 - /%6f -> /%6F
6355 - /%zz -> /%zz
6356
6357 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6358 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6359
6360 Example:
6361 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6362
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006363 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006364 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6365 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6366
6367 Example:
6368 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6369 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6370 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006372http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006374 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6375 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6376 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6377 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6378 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006382 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6383 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6384 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6385 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006387http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6388 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006389
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006390 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006391 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6392 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6393 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6394 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6395 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006396
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006397 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6398 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6399 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6400 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6401 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006402
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006403 Example:
6404 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6405
6406 # applied to:
6407 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6408
6409 # outputs:
6410 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6411
6412 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006413
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006414 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6415
6416 # applied to:
6417 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006418
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006419 # outputs:
6420 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006421
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006422http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6424
6425 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6426 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006427 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6428 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6429 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006430
6431 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6432 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6433 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6434
6435 Example:
6436 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6437 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6438
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006439 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6440 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6441 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6442 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6443
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006444http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6446
6447 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6448 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6449 query-string are replaced.
6450
6451 Example:
6452 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6453 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6454
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006455http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6456 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006458 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6459 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6460 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6461 against.
6462
6463 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6464 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6465 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006466
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006467 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6468 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6469 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6470 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6471 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6472 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6473 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6474 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6475 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006476 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6477 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006479 Example:
6480 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6481 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006482
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006483 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6484 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006486http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6487 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006488
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006489 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6490 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6491 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6492 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006493
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006494 Example:
6495 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006496
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006497 # applied to:
6498 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006499
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006500 # outputs:
6501 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006502
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006503http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6504 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6505 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006506 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6508
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006509 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006510 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6511 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006512 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006513 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006514 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006515 are followed to create the response :
6516
6517 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6518 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6519 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6520 ignored.
6521
6522 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6523 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006524 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006525 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6526 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006527
6528 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6529 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6530 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006531 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006532 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006533
6534 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6535 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6536 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006537 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006538 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006539 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006540
6541 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6542 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6543 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6544 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6545 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6546 as a raw content.
6547
6548 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6549 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6550 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6551 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6552 considered as a raw string.
6553
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006554 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006555 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6556 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6557 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6558
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006559 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6560 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006561 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006562
6563 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6564
6565 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006566 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006567 if { path /ping }
6568
6569 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6570 if { path /favicon.ico }
6571
6572 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6573 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6574 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006576http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6577http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006579 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6580 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6581 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006582
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006583http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6584 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006585
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006586 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6587 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6588 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6589 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006591http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006593 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6594 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6595 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6596 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6597 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 Arguments:
6600 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6601 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603 Example:
6604 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6605 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006607 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6608 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006610http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6613 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6614 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 Arguments:
6617 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6618 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 Example:
6621 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6622 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6625 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6626 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006628http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6631 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6632 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6633 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6634 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636 Example:
6637 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6638 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6639 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6640 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6641 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6642 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6643 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6644 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6645 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006649 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6650 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6651 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6652 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6653 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006655http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6656 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006658 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6659 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6660 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6661 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6662 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6663 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6664 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6665 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6666 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6671 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6672 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6673 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6674 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6675 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6676 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006678http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6681 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6682 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006684http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006686 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6687 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6688 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6689 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6690 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6691 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6692 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6693 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006697 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6698 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6699 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6700 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6701 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6702 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006704 Example :
6705 # prepend the host name before the path
6706 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006707
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006708http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6709
6710 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6711 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6712 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006714http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006716 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6717 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6718 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6719 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6720 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006724 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6725 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6726 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6727 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6728 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6729 values have higher priority.
6730 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6731 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6732 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6733 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6734 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006738 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6739 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6740 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6741 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6742 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6743 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6744 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006747
6748 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6750 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006752http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6753 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6754 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6755 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006756 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6757 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758
6759 Arguments :
6760 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6761 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006762
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006763 See also "option forwardfor".
6764
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006765 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006766 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6767 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6768
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006769 # After the masking this will track connections
6770 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6771 http-request track-sc0 src
6772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006773 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6774 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6775
6776http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6777
6778 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6779 expression.
6780
6781 Arguments:
6782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6783 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006784
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006785 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006786 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6787 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6788
6789 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6790 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6791 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6792
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006793http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006794 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6795
6796 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6797 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6798 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6799 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6800 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6801
6802 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6803 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6804 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6805 results.
6806
6807 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006808 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6809 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006811http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6812
6813 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6814 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6815 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6816 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6817 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6818 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6819 information from the request.
6820
6821 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6822
6823http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824
6825 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6826 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006827 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6828 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6829 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6830 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6831 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006832 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6833
6834http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6835
6836 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6837 inline.
6838
6839 Arguments:
6840 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6841 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6842 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6843 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6844 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6845 (request and response)
6846 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6847 processing
6848 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6849 processing
6850 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6851 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6852 and '_'.
6853
6854 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6855 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006856
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006857 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006858 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006860http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006863 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6864 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6865 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6866 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6867 agent name must be used.
6868
6869 Arguments:
6870 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6871
6872 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6873 configuration.
6874
6875http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6876
6877 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6878 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6879 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6880 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6881 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6882 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6883 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6884 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6885 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6886 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6887 action.
6888 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6889 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6890 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6891 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6892 you fully understand how it works.
6893
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006894http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6895
6896 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6897 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6898 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6899 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6900 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006901 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006902 processing.
6903
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006904 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006905 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6906 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6907 rules evaluation.
6908
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006909http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6910http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6911 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6912 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6913 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6914 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006915
6916 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6917 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6918 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006919 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6920 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6921 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6922 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6923 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6924 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006925 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006926 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6927 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6928 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006929 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006930 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6931 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6932 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6933 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6934 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006935
6936http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6937http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6938http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6939
6940 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6941 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6942 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6943 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006944 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006945 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6946 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6947 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6948 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6949 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6950 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6951 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6952
6953 Arguments :
6954 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6955 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6956 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6957 select which table entry to update the counters.
6958
6959 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6960 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6961 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6962 that table until the session ends.
6963
6964 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6965 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6966 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6967 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6968 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6969 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6970 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6971 useful information.
6972
6973 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6974 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6975 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6976 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6977 checks that make use of it.
6978
6979http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6980
6981 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006982
6983 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006984 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006985
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006986http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6987
6988 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6989 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6990 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6991 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6992 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6993 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6994
6995 Arguments :
6996 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6997
6998 Example:
6999 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7000
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007001http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7003
7004 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7005 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7006 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7007 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7008 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7009 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7010 http-buffer-request".
7011
7012 Arguments :
7013
7014 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7015 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7016
7017 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007018 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007019 bytes.
7020
7021 Example:
7022 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7023
7024 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007026http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007028 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7029 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7030 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007031
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007034 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7035
7036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7037 no | yes | yes | yes
7038
7039 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7040 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7041 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7042 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7043 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7044 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007046 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7047 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007049 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051 Example:
7052 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7057 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059 Example:
7060 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007062 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007064 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7065 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7068 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007070http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007072 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7073 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7074 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7075 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7076 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7077 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7078 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7079 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007083 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7084 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7085 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7086 example, or to pass some internal information.
7087 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7088 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7089 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007091http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7094 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007095
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007096http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007097
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007098 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007100http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007102 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7103 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7104 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7105 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7106 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7107 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7108 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7111 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7112 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7113 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7114 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007115
7116 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7117 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7118 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7119 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007121http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007123 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7124 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7125 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7126 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7127 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7128 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007129
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007130http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007131
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007132 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7133 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7134 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7135 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7136 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007138http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007140 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7141 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7142 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7143 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7144 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7145 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007146
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007147http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7148http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7149 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7150 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7151 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7152 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007153
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007154 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7155 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7156 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007157 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007158 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7159 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7160 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007161 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007162 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007164http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007166 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7167 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7168 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7169 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7170 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7171 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007173http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7174 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007175
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007176 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7177 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007179 Example:
7180 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007182 # applied to:
7183 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007185 # outputs:
7186 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007188 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007190http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7191 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007192
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007193 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007194 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007196 Example:
7197 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007199 # applied to:
7200 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007202 # outputs:
7203 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007204
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007205http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7206 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7207 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007208 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007209 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7210
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007211 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007212 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7213 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007214 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007215 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007216 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007217 are followed to create the response :
7218
7219 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7220 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7221 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7222 ignored.
7223
7224 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7225 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007226 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007227 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7228 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007229
7230 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7231 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7232 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007233 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007234 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007235
7236 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7237 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7238 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007239 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007240 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007241 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007242
7243 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7244 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7245 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7246 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7247 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7248 as a raw content.
7249
7250 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7251 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7252 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7253 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7254 considered as a raw string.
7255
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007256 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7257 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7258 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7259 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7260
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007261 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7262 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007263 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007264
7265 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7266
7267 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007268 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007269 if { status eq 404 }
7270
7271 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7272 string "This is the end !" \
7273 if { status eq 500 }
7274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007275http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7276http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007277
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007278 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7279 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7280 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007281
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007282http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7283 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007284
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007285 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7286 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7287 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7288 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007289
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007290http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7291 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7294 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7295 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7296 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7297 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007299 Arguments:
7300 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007301
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007302 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7303 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007305http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007306
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007307 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7308 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7309 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007311http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7312
7313 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7314 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7315 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7316 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7317 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7318
7319http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7320
7321 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7322 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7323 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7324 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7325 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7326 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7327 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7328 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7329 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7330
7331http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7332
7333 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7334 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7335 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7336 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7337 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7338 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7339 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7340
7341http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7342
7343 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7344 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7345 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7346 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7347 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7348 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7349 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7350 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7351
7352http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7353 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7354
7355 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7356 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7357 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7358 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007359
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007360 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007361 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7362 http-response set-status 431
7363 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7364 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007365
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007366http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007367
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007368 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7369 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7370 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7371 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7372 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7373 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7374 based on some information from the request.
7375
7376 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7377
7378http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7379
7380 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7381 inline.
7382
7383 Arguments:
7384 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7385 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7386 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7387 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7388 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7389 (request and response)
7390 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7391 processing
7392 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7393 processing
7394 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7395 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7396 and '_'.
7397
7398 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7399 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007400
7401 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007402 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007403
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007404http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007405
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007406 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7407 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7408 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7409 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7410 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7411 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7412 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7413 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7414 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7415 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7416 action.
7417 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7418 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7419 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7420 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7421 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007422
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007423http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7424
7425 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7426 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7427 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7428 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7429 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007430 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007431 processing.
7432
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007433 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007434 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007435 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007436 rules evaluation.
7437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007438http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7439http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7440http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007442 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7443 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7444 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7445 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7446 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007447 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007448
7449http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7450
7451 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7452 about <var-name>.
7453
7454 Example:
7455 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7456
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007457http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7458 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7459
7460 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7461 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7462 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7463 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7464 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7465 buffer is full.
7466
7467 Arguments :
7468
7469 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7470 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7471
7472 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007473 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007474 bytes.
7475
7476 Example:
7477 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007478
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007479http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7480 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7481
7482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7483 yes | no | yes | yes
7484
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007485 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007486 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7487 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7488 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007489
7490 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7491
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007492 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7493 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7494 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7495 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7496 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7497 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7498 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007499 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007500 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7501 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007502
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007503 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7504 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7505 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7506 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7507 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7508 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7509 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007510 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7511 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7512 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7513 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7514 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7515 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007516
7517 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7518 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7519 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7520 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7521 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7522 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7523 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7524 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007525 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007526 downsides of rare connection failures.
7527
7528 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7529 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7530 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7531 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7532 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7533 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007534 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007535 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7536 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7537 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7538 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7539 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7540
7541 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007542 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7543 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7544 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7545 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007546
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007547 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7548 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007549
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007550 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007551
7552 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7553 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7554 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7555
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007556 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7557 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7558 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7559 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7560 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7561 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7562 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7563 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7564 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7565 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7566 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7567
7568 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7569 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7570 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7571 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7572 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7573
7574 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7575 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007576
7577
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007578http-send-name-header [<header>]
7579 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7581 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007582 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007583 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7584
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007585 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7586 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7587 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7588 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7589 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7590 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7591 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7592 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7593 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7594 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7595 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7596 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7597 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7598 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7599 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7600 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007601
7602 See also : "server"
7603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007604id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007605 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7607 no | yes | yes | yes
7608 Arguments : none
7609
7610 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7611 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7612 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007613
7614
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007615ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7616 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007618 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007619
7620 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7621 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7622 and running).
7623
7624 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7625 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7626 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007627 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007628 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7629
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007630 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7631 "unless" condition is met.
7632
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007633 Example:
7634 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7635 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7636 ignore-persist if url_static
7637
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007638 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7639
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007640load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7641 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7643 yes | no | yes | yes
7644
7645 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7646 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7647 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007648 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007649 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007650 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7651 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7652 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7653
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007654 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007655 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007656 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007657
7658 Arguments:
7659 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7660 named "server-state-file".
7661
7662 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7663 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7664 name is used as a file name.
7665
7666 none don't load any stat for this backend
7667
7668 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007669 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7670 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7671 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007672 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007673 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007674
7675 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7676 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7677
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007678 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007680 global
7681 stats socket /tmp/socket
7682 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007683
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007684 defaults
7685 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007686
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007687 backend bk
7688 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7689 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007690
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007691
7692 Then one can run :
7693
7694 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7695
7696 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7697
7698 1
7699 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7700 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7701 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7702
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007703 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007704
7705 global
7706 stats socket /tmp/socket
7707 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7708
7709 defaults
7710 load-server-state-from-file local
7711
7712 backend bk
7713 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7714 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7715
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007716
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007717 Then one can run :
7718
7719 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7720
7721 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7722
7723 1
7724 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7725 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7726 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7727
7728 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7729 "show servers state"
7730
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007732log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007733log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007734 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007735no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007736 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7738 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007739
7740 Prefix :
7741 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7742 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7743 prefix does not allow arguments.
7744
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007745 Arguments :
7746 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7747 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7748 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7749 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7750 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7751 parameter.
7752
7753 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7754 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7755
7756 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7757 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7758 standard syslog port).
7759
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007760 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7761 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7762 standard syslog port).
7763
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007764 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7765 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7766 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007767 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007768
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007769 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7770 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7771 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7772 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7773 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7774 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7775 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7776 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7777 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7778 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7779 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7780 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007781 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007782 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7783 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7784 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007785 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7786 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007787
7788 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7789 and "fd@2", see above.
7790
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007791 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7792 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7793 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7794 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7795 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7796 having the logs instantly available.
7797
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007798 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7799 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7800 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7801
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007802 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7803 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007804
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007805 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7806 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7807 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7808 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7809 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7810 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7811 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7812 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7813 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7814 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007815 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007816
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007817 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7818 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7819 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7820 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7821 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7822
7823 <sample_size>
7824 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7825 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7826 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7827 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7828 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7829
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007830 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7831 one of the following :
7832
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007833 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7834 field is stripped. This is the default.
7835 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7836 rfc3164.
7837
7838 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007839 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7840
7841 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7842 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7843
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007844 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7845 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7846 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7847 designed to be used with a local log server.
7848
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007849 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7850 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7851 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7852 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7853 systemd logger consumes.
7854
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007855 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7856 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7857 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7858 used with a local log server.
7859
7860 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7861 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7862 designed to be used with a local log server.
7863
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007864 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7865 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7866 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7867 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7868
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007869 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7870
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007871 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7872 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7873 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7874
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007875 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7876 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7877 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7878 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007879
7880 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7881 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7882 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007883 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7884 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7885 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7886 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7887 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007888
7889 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7890
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007891 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7892 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7893 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007894
7895 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7896 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7897 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7898 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7899
7900 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7901 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007902
7903 Example :
7904 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007905 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7906 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7907 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007908 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007909 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7910 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007911 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007912
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007913
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007914log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007915 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7917 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007918
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007919 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7920 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7921 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7922 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7923 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007924
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007925 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7926 "option httplog" directives.
7927
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007928log-format-sd <string>
7929 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7931 yes | yes | yes | no
7932
7933 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7934 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7935 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7936 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7937 which covers the log format string in depth.
7938
7939 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7940 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7941
7942 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7943 log format to "rfc5424".
7944
7945 Example :
7946 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7947
7948
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007949log-tag <string>
7950 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7952 yes | yes | yes | yes
7953
7954 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7955 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007956 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007957 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7958 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7959 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7960 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7961 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7962 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007963
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007964max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7965 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | no | yes | yes
7968
7969 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7970 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7971 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7972 servers.
7973
7974 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007975 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007976 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7977 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7978 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007979 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007980 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7981 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7982 picking a different server.
7983
7984 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7985 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7986 even if they have to be queued.
7987
7988 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7989 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7990
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007991max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7992 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7993 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7994 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007995
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007996maxconn <conns>
7997 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 yes | yes | yes | no
8000 Arguments :
8001 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8002 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8003 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8004 closes.
8005
8006 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008007 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008008 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8009 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008010 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8011 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8012 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8013 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014
8015 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8016 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8017 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8018
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008019 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8020 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008022 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8023
8024
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008025mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008026 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 yes | yes | yes | yes
8029 Arguments :
8030 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8031 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8032 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8033 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8034
8035 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8036 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8037 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8038 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8039 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8040
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008041 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8042 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8043 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008044
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008045 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008046 defaults http_instances
8047 mode http
8048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008049
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008050monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008051 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008054 Arguments :
8055 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8056 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008057 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008058 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8059 backend and its backup.
8060
8061 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8062 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8063 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8064 servers in a list of backends.
8065
8066 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8067 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8068 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008069 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008070 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8071 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008072 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008073 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8074 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008075
8076 Example:
8077 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008078 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008079 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8080 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8081 monitor-uri /site_alive
8082 monitor fail if site_dead
8083
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008084 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008085
8086
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008087monitor-uri <uri>
8088 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8090 yes | yes | yes | no
8091 Arguments :
8092 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8093 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8094
8095 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8096 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8097 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8098 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8099 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8100 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8101 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8102 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8103
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008104 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008105 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8106 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008107 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8108 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8109 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008110 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8111 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8112 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008113
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008114 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8115 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8116 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8117 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8118
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008119 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008120 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008121 frontend www
8122 mode http
8123 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8124
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008125 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008127
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008128option abortonclose
8129no option abortonclose
8130 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8132 yes | no | yes | yes
8133 Arguments : none
8134
8135 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8136 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8137 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8138 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008139 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008140 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8141 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8142 encountered while delivering the response.
8143
8144 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8145 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8146 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8147 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8148 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8149 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008150 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008151 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008152 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008153 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8154 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8155 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8156
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008157 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8158 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008159 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8160 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8161 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8162 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8163 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8164 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008165 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008166
8167 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8168 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8169
8170 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8171
8172
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008173option accept-invalid-http-request
8174no option accept-invalid-http-request
8175 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8177 yes | yes | yes | no
8178 Arguments : none
8179
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008180 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008181 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008182 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008183 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8184 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8185 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8186 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8187 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008188 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8189 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8190 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8191 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008192 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008193 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008194 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8195 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8196 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008197
8198 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8199 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8200 been confirmed.
8201
8202 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8203 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008204 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8205 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008206 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8207
8208 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8209 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8210
8211 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8212 stats socket.
8213
8214
8215option accept-invalid-http-response
8216no option accept-invalid-http-response
8217 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8219 yes | no | yes | yes
8220 Arguments : none
8221
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008222 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008223 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008224 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008225 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8226 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8227 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8228 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8229 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008230 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8231 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8232 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008233
8234 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8235 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8236 been confirmed.
8237
8238 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8239 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8240 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8241 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8242
8243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8245
8246 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8247 stats socket.
8248
8249
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008250option allbackups
8251no option allbackups
8252 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8254 yes | no | yes | yes
8255 Arguments : none
8256
8257 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8258 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8259 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8260 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8261 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8262 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8263 order between the backup servers anymore.
8264
8265 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8266 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8267
8268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8270
8271
8272option checkcache
8273no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008274 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 yes | no | yes | yes
8277 Arguments : none
8278
8279 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8280 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008281 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008282 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8283 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008284 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008285
8286 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008287 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008288 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008289 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8290 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008291 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008292 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008293 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8294 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008295 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008296 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8297 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008298 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008299 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8300 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8301 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8302 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8303 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8304 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8305 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8306 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8307 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8308
8309 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008310 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8311 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8312 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8313 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008314
8315 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8316 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008317 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008318 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008319
8320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8322
8323
8324option clitcpka
8325no option clitcpka
8326 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 yes | yes | yes | no
8329 Arguments : none
8330
8331 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8332 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008333 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008334 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8335
8336 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8337 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8338 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8339 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8340
8341 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8342 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8343 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8344 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8345 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8346
8347 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8348
8349 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8350 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8351 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8352
8353 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8354 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8355
8356 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8357
8358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008359option contstats
8360 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8362 yes | yes | yes | no
8363 Arguments : none
8364
8365 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8366 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8367 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008368 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008369 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8370 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8371 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8372 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8373 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008374
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008375option disable-h2-upgrade
8376no option disable-h2-upgrade
8377 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8378 connection.
8379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8380 yes | yes | yes | no
8381 Arguments : none
8382
8383 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8384 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8385 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8386 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008387 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8388 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8389 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8390 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8391 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8392 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008393
8394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008396
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008397option dontlog-normal
8398no option dontlog-normal
8399 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8401 yes | yes | yes | no
8402 Arguments : none
8403
8404 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8405 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8406 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8407 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8408 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8409 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8410 logged.
8411
8412 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8413 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8414 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008416 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008417 logging.
8418
8419
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008420option dontlognull
8421no option dontlognull
8422 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8424 yes | yes | yes | no
8425 Arguments : none
8426
8427 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8428 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8429 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8430 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8431 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8432 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008433 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8434 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8435 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008436
8437 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008438 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008439 would not be logged.
8440
8441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8443
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008444 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008445 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008446
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008447
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008448option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008449 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 yes | yes | yes | yes
8452 Arguments :
8453 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8454 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008455 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008456 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008457
8458 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8459 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8460 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8461 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8462 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8463 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8464 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008465 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8466 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8467 possible that the client has already brought one.
8468
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008469 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008470 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008471 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008472 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008473 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008474 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008475
8476 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8477 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8478 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8479 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8480 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8481 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008482 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008483
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008484 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8485 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008486 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008487 are under the control of the end-user.
8488
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008489 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008490 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8491 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008492 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8493 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8494 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008495
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008496 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008497 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8498 frontend www
8499 mode http
8500 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8501
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008502 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8503 backend www
8504 mode http
8505 option forwardfor header X-Client
8506
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008507 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008508 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008509
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008510
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008511option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8512no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8513 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8515 yes | yes | yes | no
8516 Arguments : none
8517
8518 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8519 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8520 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8521 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8522 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8523 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8524 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8525
8526 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8527 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8528 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8529 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8530 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8531 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8532 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8533 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8534 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8535 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8536
8537 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8538
8539 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8540 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8541
8542 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8543 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8544
8545
8546option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8547no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8548 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8550 yes | no | yes | yes
8551 Arguments : none
8552
8553 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8554 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8555 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8556 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8557 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8558 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8559 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8560
8561 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8562 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8563 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8564 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8565 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8566 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8567 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8568 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8569 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8570 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8571
8572 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8573
8574 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8575 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8576
8577 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8578 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8579
8580
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008581option http-buffer-request
8582no option http-buffer-request
8583 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8585 yes | yes | yes | yes
8586 Arguments : none
8587
8588 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8589 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8590 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8591 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8592 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8593 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008594 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8595 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8596 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8597 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008598
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008599 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8600 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008601
8602
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008603option http-ignore-probes
8604no option http-ignore-probes
8605 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | yes | yes | no
8608 Arguments : none
8609
8610 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8611 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8612 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8613 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8614 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8615 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8616 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8617 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8618 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008619 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8620 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008621 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8622
8623 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8624 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8625 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8626 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8627 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8628 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8629 are often the only way to detect them.
8630
8631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8633
8634 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8635
8636
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008637option http-keep-alive
8638no option http-keep-alive
8639 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8641 yes | yes | yes | yes
8642 Arguments : none
8643
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008644 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8645 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008646 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8647 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008648 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8649 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8650 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008651
8652 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8653 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008654 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8655 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8656 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8657 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8658 situations where this option may be useful :
8659
8660 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008661 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008662
8663 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8664 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8665
8666 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8667 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8668 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8669 request.
8670
8671 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8672 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008673 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8674 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8675 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008676
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008677 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8678 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8679 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8680 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8681 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8682 not set.
8683
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008684 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8685 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8686 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008687
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008688 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008689 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008690 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008691
8692
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008693option http-no-delay
8694no option http-no-delay
8695 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8697 yes | yes | yes | yes
8698 Arguments : none
8699
8700 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8701 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8702 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8703 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8704 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8705 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8706 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008707 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008708 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8709 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8710 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8711 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8712 affected.
8713
8714 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8715 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8716 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8717 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8718 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8719 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8720 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8721 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8722 latency environments.
8723
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008724 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8725
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008726
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008727option http-pretend-keepalive
8728no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008729 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008731 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008732 Arguments : none
8733
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008734 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008735 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8736 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8737 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008738 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008739 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8740 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8741 consider the response complete.
8742
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008743 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008744 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008745 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008746 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008747 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008748 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8749
8750 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8751 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8752 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8753 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008754 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8755 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008756 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8757
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008758 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8759 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8760 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8761 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8762 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8763 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008764
8765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8767
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008768 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008769 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008770
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008771option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8772 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8773 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8775 yes | yes | yes | yes
8776 Arguments :
8777 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8778 with no FastCGI application configured.
8779
8780 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8781 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8782 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8783
8784 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8785 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8786
8787 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8788 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8789 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8790 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8791 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8792 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8793 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8794 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8795
8796 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8797 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008798
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008799option http-server-close
8800no option http-server-close
8801 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8803 yes | yes | yes | yes
8804 Arguments : none
8805
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008806 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8807 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8808 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8809 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008810 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8811 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8812 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8813 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8814 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8815 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8816 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8817 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8818 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8819 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8820 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008821
8822 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8823 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8824 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8825 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008826 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8827 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008828
8829 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8830 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008831 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8832 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8833 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008834
8835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8837
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008838 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8839 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008840
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008841option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008842no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008843 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8845 yes | yes | yes | no
8846 Arguments : none
8847
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008848 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008849 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8850 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8851 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8852 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8853 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008854 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008855
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008856 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008857 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008858 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8859 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8860 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008861
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008862 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8863 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8864 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8865 front of an existing proxy.
8866
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008867 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8868
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008869 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008870
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008871option httpchk
8872option httpchk <uri>
8873option httpchk <method> <uri>
8874option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008875 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8877 yes | no | yes | yes
8878 Arguments :
8879 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8880 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8881 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8882 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8883 ones.
8884
8885 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8886 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8887 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8888
8889 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8890 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8891 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008892 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008893
8894 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8895 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8896 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8897 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8898 the lack of any response.
8899
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008900 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8901 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8902 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8903 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8904
8905 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8906 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8907 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008908
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008909 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8910 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008911 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008912 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008913 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008915 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8916 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8917 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8918 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8919
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008920 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008921 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8922 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8923 backend https_relay
8924 mode tcp
8925 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8926 http-check send hdr Host www
8927 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008928
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008929 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8930 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8931 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008932
8933
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008934option httpclose
8935no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008936 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8938 yes | yes | yes | yes
8939 Arguments : none
8940
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008941 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8942 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8943 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8944 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008945 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008946
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008947 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8948 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008949 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008950 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8951 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008952
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008953 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8954 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8955 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008956
8957 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8958 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008959 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8960 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8961 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008962
8963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8965
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008966 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008967
8968
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008969option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008970 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008972 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008973 Arguments :
8974 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8975 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8976 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008977 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008978 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008979
8980 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8981 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8982 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8983 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8984 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8985 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8986 ports.
8987
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008988 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8989 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008990
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008991 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008993 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008994
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008995
8996option http_proxy
8997no option http_proxy
8998 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9000 yes | yes | yes | yes
9001 Arguments : none
9002
9003 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
9004 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
9005 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9006 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9007 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9008
9009 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9010 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009011 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9012 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009013
9014 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9015 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9016
9017 Example :
9018 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9019 backend direct_forward
9020 option httpclose
9021 option http_proxy
9022
9023 See also : "option httpclose"
9024
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009025
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009026option independent-streams
9027no option independent-streams
9028 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9030 yes | yes | yes | yes
9031 Arguments : none
9032
9033 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9034 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9035 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9036 receive data or not.
9037
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009038 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009039 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9040 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9041 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9042 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9043 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9044 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9045 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9046 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9047 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9048 socket buffers.
9049
9050 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9051 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9052 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9053 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9054 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9055
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009056 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009057
9058
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009059option ldap-check
9060 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9062 yes | no | yes | yes
9063 Arguments : none
9064
9065 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9066 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9067 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9068 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9069
9070 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9071 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9072
9073 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9074 configure it.
9075
9076 Example :
9077 option ldap-check
9078
9079 See also : "option httpchk"
9080
9081
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009082option external-check
9083 Use external processes for server health checks
9084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9085 yes | no | yes | yes
9086
9087 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9088 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9089 command".
9090
9091 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9092
9093 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9094
9095
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009096option idle-close-on-response
9097no option idle-close-on-response
9098 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9100 yes | yes | yes | no
9101 Arguments : none
9102
9103 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9104 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9105 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9106 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9107 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9108 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9109 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9110 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9111 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9112
9113 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9114 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9115
9116 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9117 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9118 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9119 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9120
9121 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9122 "hard-stop-after"
9123
9124
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009125option log-health-checks
9126no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009127 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9129 yes | no | yes | yes
9130 Arguments : none
9131
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009132 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9133 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9134 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009135
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009136 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9137 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9138 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9139 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9140 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009142 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009143 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009144
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009145 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9146 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9147 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009148
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009149
9150option log-separate-errors
9151no option log-separate-errors
9152 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | yes | yes | no
9155 Arguments : none
9156
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009157 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009158 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9159 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9160 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9161 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9162 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9163 provides very important information.
9164
9165 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9166 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9167 error logs.
9168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009169 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009170 logging.
9171
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009172
9173option logasap
9174no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009175 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9177 yes | yes | yes | no
9178 Arguments : none
9179
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009180 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9181 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9182 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9183 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9184
9185 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9186 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9187 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9188 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9189 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009190 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009191 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9192 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9193 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9194 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009195 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009196
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009197 Examples :
9198 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9199 mode http
9200 option httplog
9201 option logasap
9202 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9203
9204 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9205 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9206 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9207 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009209 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009210 logging.
9211
9212
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009213option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009214 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9216 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009217 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009218 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9219 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009220 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9221 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009222
9223 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9224 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009225 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009226 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009227 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9228 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9229 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009230
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009231 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9232 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9233 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009234
9235 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009236 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009237 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9238 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9239 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9240 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9241 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9242 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9243 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9244
9245 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9246 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009247
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009248 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009249
9250 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9251 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9252 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9253 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009254 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009255 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009256
9257 See also: "option httpchk"
9258
9259
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009260option nolinger
9261no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009262 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009263 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9264 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009265 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009266
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009267 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009268 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9269 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9270 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9271 connections.
9272
9273 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9274 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009275 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9276 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9277 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9278 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9279 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9280 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9281 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9282 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9283 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9284 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9285 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9286 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9287 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009288
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009289 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9290 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9291 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9292 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9293 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009294
9295 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9296 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009297 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009298 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009299 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009300
9301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9303
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009304 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9305 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009306
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009307option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9308 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9310 yes | yes | yes | yes
9311 Arguments :
9312 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9313 matching <network>
9314 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9315 header name.
9316
9317 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9318 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9319 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9320 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9321 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9322 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9323 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9324 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9325 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9326 possible that the client has already brought one.
9327
9328 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9329 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9330 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9331 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9332 header and requires different one.
9333
9334 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9335 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9336 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009337 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9338 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9339 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9340 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9341 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009342
9343 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9344 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9345 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9346 both are defined.
9347
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009348 Examples :
9349 # Original Destination address
9350 frontend www
9351 mode http
9352 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9353
9354 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9355 backend www
9356 mode http
9357 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9358
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009359 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009360
9361
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009362option persist
9363no option persist
9364 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9366 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009367 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009368
9369 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9370 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9371 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9372 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9373 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9374 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9375 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9376 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9377 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9378 redirected to another valid server.
9379
9380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9382
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009383 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009384
9385
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009386option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009387 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9389 yes | no | yes | yes
9390 Arguments :
9391 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9392 PostgreSQL server.
9393
9394 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9395 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9396 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9397 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9398
9399 See also: "option httpchk"
9400
9401
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009402option prefer-last-server
9403no option prefer-last-server
9404 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9405 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9406 yes | no | yes | yes
9407 Arguments : none
9408
9409 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009410 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009411 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9412 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009413 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009414 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009415 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009416 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9417 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009418 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009419 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009420 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9421 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9422 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009423 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9424 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9425 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009426
9427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9429
9430 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9431
9432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009433option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009434option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009435no option redispatch
9436 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9437 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9438 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009439 Arguments :
9440 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9441 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9442 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009443 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009444 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009445 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009446 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9447 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9448 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009450
9451 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9452 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9453 be able to access the service anymore.
9454
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009455 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9456 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009457
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009458 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9459 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9460 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9461 following order:
9462
9463 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9464
9465 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9466 list, or
9467
9468 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9469
9470 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9471 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9472
9473 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9474 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9475 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9476 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9477
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009478 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009479 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9480 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9484
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009485 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009486
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009487
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009488option redis-check
9489 Use redis health checks for server testing
9490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9491 yes | no | yes | yes
9492 Arguments : none
9493
9494 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9495 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9496 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9497 find the "+PONG" response message.
9498
9499 Example :
9500 option redis-check
9501
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009502 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009503
9504
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009505option smtpchk
9506option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9507 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9509 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009510 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009511 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009512 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009513 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9514
9515 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9516 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9517 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9518
9519 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9520 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9521 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9522 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9523 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9524 dead server.
9525
9526 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9527 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009528 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009529 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9530
9531 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9532 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9533 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9534 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009535 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009536
9537 Example :
9538 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9539
9540 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009543option socket-stats
9544no option socket-stats
9545
9546 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9548 yes | yes | yes | no
9549
9550 Arguments : none
9551
9552
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009553option splice-auto
9554no option splice-auto
9555 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 yes | yes | yes | yes
9558 Arguments : none
9559
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009560 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009561 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009562 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009563 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009564 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009565 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9566 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9567 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9568 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9569
9570 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9571 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9572 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9573 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9574 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9575 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9576 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9577 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9578 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9579 keyword.
9580
9581 Example :
9582 option splice-auto
9583
9584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9586
9587 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9588 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9589
9590
9591option splice-request
9592no option splice-request
9593 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9595 yes | yes | yes | yes
9596 Arguments : none
9597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009598 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009599 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009600 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9601 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9602 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9603 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9604
9605 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9606
9607 Example :
9608 option splice-request
9609
9610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9612
9613 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9614 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9615
9616
9617option splice-response
9618no option splice-response
9619 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 yes | yes | yes | yes
9622 Arguments : none
9623
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009624 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009625 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009626 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9627 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9628 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9629 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9630
9631 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9632
9633 Example :
9634 option splice-response
9635
9636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9638
9639 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9640 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9641
9642
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009643option spop-check
9644 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009646 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009647 Arguments : none
9648
9649 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9650 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9651 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9652 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9653
9654 Example :
9655 option spop-check
9656
9657 See also : "option httpchk"
9658
9659
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009660option srvtcpka
9661no option srvtcpka
9662 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9664 yes | no | yes | yes
9665 Arguments : none
9666
9667 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9668 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009669 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009670 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9671
9672 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9673 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9674 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9675 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9676
9677 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9678 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9679 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9680 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9681 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9682
9683 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9684
9685 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9686 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9687 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9688
9689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9691
9692 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9693
9694
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009695option ssl-hello-chk
9696 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9698 yes | no | yes | yes
9699 Arguments : none
9700
9701 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9702 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9703 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9704 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9705 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9706 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9707 hello message.
9708
9709 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9710 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9711 messages, which is appreciable.
9712
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009713 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009714 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9715 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009716
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009717 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9718
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009719
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009720option tcp-check
9721 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9723 yes | no | yes | yes
9724
9725 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9726 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9727
9728 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9729 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9730 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9731
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009732 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009733 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9734 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9735 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9736 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9737 only.
9738
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009739 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009740 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009741 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9742 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9743 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9744
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009745 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9747 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009748 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009749 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9750 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9751 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9752 the respective protocols.
9753 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009754 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009755
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009756 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009757
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009758 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9759 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9760 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9761 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009762
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009763 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9764 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9765 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009766
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009767
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009768 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009769 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009770 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009771 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009772
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009773 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009774 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009775 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009776
9777 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9778 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009779 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009780 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009781 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009782 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009783 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009784 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009785 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9786 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009787 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009788 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9789 tcp-check expect string +OK
9790
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009791 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009792 (send many headers before analyzing)
9793 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009794 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009795 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9796 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9797 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9798 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009799 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009800
9801
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009802 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009803
9804
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009805option tcp-smart-accept
9806no option tcp-smart-accept
9807 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9809 yes | yes | yes | no
9810 Arguments : none
9811
9812 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9813 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9814 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9815 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9816 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9817 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9818
9819 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9820 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9821 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9822 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9823
9824 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9825 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9826 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009827 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009828
9829 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9830 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9831 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9832
9833 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9834 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9835 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9836
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009837 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9838
9839
9840option tcp-smart-connect
9841no option tcp-smart-connect
9842 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9844 yes | no | yes | yes
9845 Arguments : none
9846
9847 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9848 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9849 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9850 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9851 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9852
9853 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9854 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9855 complex.
9856
9857 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9858 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9859 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9860
9861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9863
9864 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9865
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009866
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009867option tcpka
9868 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9870 yes | yes | yes | yes
9871 Arguments : none
9872
9873 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9874 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009875 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009876 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9877
9878 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9879 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9880 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9881 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9882
9883 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9884 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9885 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9886 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9887 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9888
9889 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9890
9891 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9892 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9893 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9894 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9895 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9896 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9897 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9898 backends.
9899
9900 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9901
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009902
9903option tcplog
9904 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009906 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009907 Arguments : none
9908
9909 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9910 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9911 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9912 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9913 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9914 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9915 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9916 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9917
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009918 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009920 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009921
9922
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009923option transparent
9924no option transparent
9925 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009927 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009928 Arguments : none
9929
9930 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9931 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9932 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9933 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9934 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9935 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9936 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9937 appropriate server.
9938
9939 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9940 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9941
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009942 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009943 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009944
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009945
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009946external-check command <command>
9947 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9949 yes | no | yes | yes
9950
9951 Arguments :
9952 <command> is the external command to run
9953
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009954 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9955
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009956 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009957
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009958 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9959 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9960 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9961 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9962 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9963 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009964
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009965 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9966
9967 Environment variables :
9968 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9969 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9970
9971 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9972
9973 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9974
9975 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9976 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9977 for a UNIX socket).
9978
9979 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9980
9981 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9982
9983 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9984
9985 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9986
9987 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9988
9989 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9990 socket).
9991
9992 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9993 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9994
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009995 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9996
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009997 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9998 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9999 failed.
10000
10001 Example :
10002 external-check command /bin/true
10003
10004 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10005
10006
10007external-check path <path>
10008 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10010 yes | no | yes | yes
10011
10012 Arguments :
10013 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10014
10015 The default path is "".
10016
10017 Example :
10018 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10019
10020 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10021 "external-check command"
10022
10023
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010024persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010025persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010026 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10028 yes | no | yes | yes
10029 Arguments :
10030 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010031 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10032 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010033
10034 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10035 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010036 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010037 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10038 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10039 forwarded to this server.
10040
10041 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10042 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10043 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010044 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010045 a single "listen" section.
10046
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010047 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10048 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10049 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10050
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010051 Example :
10052 listen tse-farm
10053 bind :3389
10054 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10055 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10056 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10057 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10058 persist rdp-cookie
10059 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010060 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010061 balance rdp-cookie
10062 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10063 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10064
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010065 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010066
10067
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010068rate-limit sessions <rate>
10069 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10071 yes | yes | yes | no
10072 Arguments :
10073 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10074 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10075
10076 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10077 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10078 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010079 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010080 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10081 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10082
10083 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10084 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10085 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10086 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10087
10088 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10089 listen smtp
10090 mode tcp
10091 bind :25
10092 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010093 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010094
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010095 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10096 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10097 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010098
10099 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10100
10101
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010102redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10103redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10104redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010105 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 no | yes | yes | yes
10108
10109 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010110 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010111
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010112 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010113 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010114 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10115 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10116 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010117
10118 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10119 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10120 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10121 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10122 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010123 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10124 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10125 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10126 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010127
10128 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10129 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10130 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10131 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10132 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10133 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010134 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010135 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010136 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10137 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10138 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010139
10140 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010141 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10142 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10143 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010144 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010145 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10146 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10147 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10148 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010149
10150 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010151 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010152
10153 - "drop-query"
10154 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10155 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10156 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10157 with a location-type redirect.
10158
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010159 - "append-slash"
10160 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10161 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10162 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10163 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10164
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010165 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10166 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10167 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10168 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10169 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10170 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10171 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10172
10173 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10174 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10175 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10176 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10177 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10178 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10179 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010180
10181 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10182 acl clear dst_port 80
10183 acl secure dst_port 8080
10184 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010185 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010186 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010187 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10188
10189 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010190 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10191 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10192 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010193 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010194
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010195 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10196 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10197 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10198
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010199 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010200 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010201
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010202 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010203 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10204 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10205 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010207 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010208
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010209
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010210retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010211 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10213 yes | no | yes | yes
10214 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010215 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10216 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010217
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010218 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10219 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10220 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10221 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10222 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010223
10224 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010225 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010226 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010227
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010228 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10229 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10230 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010231
10232 See also : "option redispatch"
10233
10234
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010235retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010236 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10237 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10238 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10240 yes | no | yes | yes
10241 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010242 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10243 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10244 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10245 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10246 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010247
10248 none never retry
10249
10250 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10251 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10252
10253 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10254 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10255 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10256 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10257 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10258 processing the request.
10259
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010260 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10261 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10262 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10263 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10264 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10265 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10266 overflow attack for example).
10267
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010268 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10269 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10270 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10271 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10272 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10273 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10274 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10275 amplify denial of service attacks.
10276
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010277 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10278 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10279 considered to be safe to retry.
10280
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010281 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10282 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10283 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10284 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10285 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010286
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010287 all-retryable-errors
10288 retry request for any error that are considered
10289 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10290 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10291 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10292
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010293 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10294 not cumulative.
10295
10296 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10297 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10298 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10299 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10300
10301 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10302 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10303 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10304 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10305 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10306 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10307 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10308 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10309 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10310 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10311 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10312 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10313
10314 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10315 should not use this directive.
10316
10317 The default is "conn-failure".
10318
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010319 Example:
10320 retry-on 503 504
10321
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010322 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10323
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010324server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010325 Declare a server in a backend
10326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10327 no | no | yes | yes
10328 Arguments :
10329 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010330 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010331 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010332
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010333 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10334 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10335 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10336 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010337 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10338 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010339 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010340 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10341 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010342 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10343 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10344 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10345 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10346 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10347 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10348 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010349 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010350 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10351 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10352 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10353 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10354 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10355 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010356 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10357 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010358 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10359 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010361 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010362 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10363 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10364 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10365 adding this value to the client's port.
10366
10367 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10368 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010369 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010370
10371 Examples :
10372 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10373 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010374 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010375 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10376 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10377 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010378
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010379 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10380 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10381 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10382 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10383 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10384
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010385 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10386 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010387
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010388server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010389 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010390 this backend.
10391 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10392 no | no | yes | yes
10393
10394 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10395 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10396 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10397 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10398 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010399
10400 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10401 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10402
10403 global
10404 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10405
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010406 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010407 load-server-state-from-file
10408
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010409 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010410 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010411
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010412server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10413 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10414 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10416 no | no | yes | yes
10417
10418 Arguments:
10419 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10420
10421 <num | range>
10422 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10423 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10424 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10425 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10426
10427 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10428
10429 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10430
10431 <params*>
10432 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10433 keyword.
10434
10435 Examples:
10436 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10437 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10438 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10439
10440 # or
10441 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10442
10443 # would be equivalent to:
10444 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10445 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10446 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10447
10448
10449
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010450source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010451source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010452source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010453 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 yes | no | yes | yes
10456 Arguments :
10457 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10458 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010459
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010460 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010461 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10462 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10463 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10464 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10465 supported prefixes are :
10466 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10467 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10468 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010469 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010470 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10471 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010472
10473 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10474 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010475 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10476 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10477 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010478
10479 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10480 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10481 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10482 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10483 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10484 <addr>.
10485
10486 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10487 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10488 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10489 port.
10490
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010491 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10492 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10493 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10494 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010495 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010496 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10497 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10498 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10499 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10500 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10501 HTTP header.
10502
10503 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10504 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010505 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010506 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10507 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10508 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10509 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10510 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10511 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10512 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10513
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010514 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10515 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10516 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10517 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10518 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10519 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10520
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010521 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10522 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10523 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10524 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10525
10526 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10527 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10528 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10529 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10530 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10531 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10532
10533 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10534 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10535 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10536 there are two methods :
10537
10538 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10539 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10540 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10541 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10542 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10543 of the client ranges may be used.
10544
10545 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10546 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10547 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10548 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10549 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10550 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10551 same session.
10552
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010553 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10554 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10555 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010556 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010557
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010558 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10559
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010560 Examples :
10561 backend private
10562 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10563 source 192.168.1.200
10564
10565 backend transparent_ssl1
10566 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10567 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10568
10569 backend transparent_ssl2
10570 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10571 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10572 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10573
10574 backend transparent_ssl3
10575 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10576 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10577 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10578
10579 backend transparent_smtp
10580 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10581 # with Tproxy version 4.
10582 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10583
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010584 backend transparent_http
10585 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10586 # proxy.
10587 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010589 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010590 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10591
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010592
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010593srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10594 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10595 the connection on the server side.
10596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10597 yes | no | yes | yes
10598 Arguments :
10599 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10600
10601 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10602 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010603 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10604 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010605
10606 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10607
10608
10609srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10610 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10611 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10612 server side.
10613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10614 yes | no | yes | yes
10615 Arguments :
10616 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10617 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10618 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10619 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10620
10621 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10622 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010623 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10624 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010625
10626 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10627
10628
10629srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10630 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10632 yes | no | yes | yes
10633 Arguments :
10634 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10635 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10636 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10637 document.
10638
10639 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10640 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010641 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10642 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010643
10644 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10645
10646
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010647stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10648 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010650 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010651
10652 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10653 matched.
10654
10655 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10656 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10657
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010658 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10659 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010660 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010661
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010662 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10663 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10664 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10665 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010666
10667 Example :
10668 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10669 backend stats_localhost
10670 stats enable
10671 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10672
10673 Example :
10674 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10675 backend stats_auth
10676 stats enable
10677 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10678 stats admin if TRUE
10679
10680 Example :
10681 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10682 userlist stats-auth
10683 group admin users admin
10684 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10685 group readonly users haproxy
10686 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10687
10688 backend stats_auth
10689 stats enable
10690 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10691 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10692 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10693 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10694
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010695 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10696 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10697 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010698
10699
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010700stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10701 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010704 Arguments :
10705 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10706
10707 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10708
10709 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10710 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10711 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10712 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10713 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10714 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10715
10716 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10717 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10718 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010719 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010720
10721 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10722 report using "stats scope".
10723
10724 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10725 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10726 unobvious parameters.
10727
10728 Example :
10729 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10730 backend public_www
10731 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10732 stats enable
10733 stats hide-version
10734 stats scope .
10735 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010736 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010737 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10738 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10739
10740 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10741 backend private_monitoring
10742 stats enable
10743 stats uri /admin?stats
10744 stats refresh 5s
10745
10746 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10747
10748
10749stats enable
10750 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010752 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010753 Arguments : none
10754
10755 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10756 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10757 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10758 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10759 - stats auth : no authentication
10760 - stats scope : no restriction
10761
10762 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10763 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10764 unobvious parameters.
10765
10766 Example :
10767 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10768 backend public_www
10769 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10770 stats enable
10771 stats hide-version
10772 stats scope .
10773 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010774 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010775 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10776 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10777
10778 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10779 backend private_monitoring
10780 stats enable
10781 stats uri /admin?stats
10782 stats refresh 5s
10783
10784 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10785
10786
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010787stats hide-version
10788 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010790 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010791 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010793 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10794 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10795 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10796 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10797 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10798 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010800 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10801 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10802 unobvious parameters.
10803
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010804 Example :
10805 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10806 backend public_www
10807 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010808 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010809 stats hide-version
10810 stats scope .
10811 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010812 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10814 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010815
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010816 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10817 backend private_monitoring
10818 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010819 stats uri /admin?stats
10820 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010821
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010822 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010824
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010825stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10826 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10827 Access control for statistics
10828
10829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10830 no | no | yes | yes
10831
10832 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10833 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10834 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10835 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10836 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10837 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10838
10839 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10840 instance.
10841
10842 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10843 about ACL usage.
10844
10845
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010846stats realm <realm>
10847 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010850 Arguments :
10851 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10852 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10853 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10854
10855 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10856 using a backslash ('\').
10857
10858 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10859 only related to authentication.
10860
10861 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10862 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10863 unobvious parameters.
10864
10865 Example :
10866 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10867 backend public_www
10868 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10869 stats enable
10870 stats hide-version
10871 stats scope .
10872 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010873 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010874 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10875 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10876
10877 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10878 backend private_monitoring
10879 stats enable
10880 stats uri /admin?stats
10881 stats refresh 5s
10882
10883 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10884
10885
10886stats refresh <delay>
10887 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010889 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010890 Arguments :
10891 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10892 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10893 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10894 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10895 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10896 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10897
10898 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10899 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10900 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010901 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010902
10903 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10904 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10905 unobvious parameters.
10906
10907 Example :
10908 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10909 backend public_www
10910 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10911 stats enable
10912 stats hide-version
10913 stats scope .
10914 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010915 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010916 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10917 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10918
10919 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10920 backend private_monitoring
10921 stats enable
10922 stats uri /admin?stats
10923 stats refresh 5s
10924
10925 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10926
10927
10928stats scope { <name> | "." }
10929 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010931 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010932 Arguments :
10933 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10934 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10935 section in which the statement appears.
10936
10937 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10938 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10939 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10940 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10941 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10942 exists.
10943
10944 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10945 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10946 unobvious parameters.
10947
10948 Example :
10949 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10950 backend public_www
10951 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10952 stats enable
10953 stats hide-version
10954 stats scope .
10955 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010957 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10958 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10959
10960 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10961 backend private_monitoring
10962 stats enable
10963 stats uri /admin?stats
10964 stats refresh 5s
10965
10966 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10967
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010968
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010969stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010970 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010972 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010973
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010974 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010975 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10976
10977 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10978 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10979
10980 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10981 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010982 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010983
10984 Example :
10985 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10986 backend private_monitoring
10987 stats enable
10988 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10989 stats uri /admin?stats
10990 stats refresh 5s
10991
10992 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10993 global section.
10994
10995
10996stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010997 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10999 yes | yes | yes | yes
11000 Arguments : none
11001
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011002 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011003 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11004 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11005 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11006 - IP (socket, server)
11007 - cookie (backend, server)
11008
11009 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11010 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011011 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011012
11013 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11014
11015
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011016stats show-modules
11017 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11019 yes | yes | yes | yes
11020 Arguments : none
11021
11022 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11023 values as a tooltip.
11024
11025 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11026 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11027 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11028
11029 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11030
11031
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011032stats show-node [ <name> ]
11033 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011035 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011036 Arguments:
11037 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11038 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11039
11040 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11041 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011042 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011043
11044 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11045 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11046 unobvious parameters.
11047
11048 Example:
11049 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11050 backend private_monitoring
11051 stats enable
11052 stats show-node Europe-1
11053 stats uri /admin?stats
11054 stats refresh 5s
11055
11056 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11057 section.
11058
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011059
11060stats uri <prefix>
11061 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011063 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011064 Arguments :
11065 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11066 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11067 query string.
11068
11069 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11070 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11071 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11072 possible to reach it in the application.
11073
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011074 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011075 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011076 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11077 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11078 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11079 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11080
11081 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11082 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11083 an address or a port to statistics only.
11084
11085 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11086 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11087 unobvious parameters.
11088
11089 Example :
11090 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11091 backend public_www
11092 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11093 stats enable
11094 stats hide-version
11095 stats scope .
11096 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011097 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011098 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11099 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11100
11101 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11102 backend private_monitoring
11103 stats enable
11104 stats uri /admin?stats
11105 stats refresh 5s
11106
11107 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11108
11109
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011110stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11111 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011113 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011114
11115 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011116 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011117 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011118 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011119 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11120
11121 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11122 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11123 the "stick-table" statement.
11124
11125 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11126 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11127 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11128 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11129 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11130
11131 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11132 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11133 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11134 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11135 transformation rules.
11136
11137 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11138 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11139 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11140 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11141 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11142 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11143 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11144
11145 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11146 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11147 ACL based conditions.
11148
11149 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11150 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11151 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11152 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11153
11154 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11155 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11156 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11157 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11158
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011159 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11160 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011162
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011163 Example :
11164 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11165 # last 30 minutes
11166 backend pop
11167 mode tcp
11168 balance roundrobin
11169 stick store-request src
11170 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11171 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11172 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11173
11174 backend smtp
11175 mode tcp
11176 balance roundrobin
11177 stick match src table pop
11178 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11179 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11180
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011181 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011182 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011183
11184
11185stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11186 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11188 no | no | yes | yes
11189
11190 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11191 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11192 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11193 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11194
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011195 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11196 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011197 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011198
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011199 Examples :
11200 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011201 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011202
11203 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11204 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11205 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11206
11207
11208 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11209 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11210 backend http
11211 mode http
11212 balance roundrobin
11213 stick on src table https
11214 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11215 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11216 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11217
11218 backend https
11219 mode tcp
11220 balance roundrobin
11221 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11222 stick on src
11223 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11224 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11225
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011226 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011227
11228
11229stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11230 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11232 no | no | yes | yes
11233
11234 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011235 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011236 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011237 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011238 server is selected.
11239
11240 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11241 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11242 the "stick-table" statement.
11243
11244 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11245 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11246 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11247 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11248 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11249 address.
11250
11251 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11252 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11253 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11254 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11255 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11256 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11257 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11258 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11259 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11260 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11261
11262 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11263 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11264 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11265 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11266 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11267 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11268 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11269
11270 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11271 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11272 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11273 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11274
11275 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11276 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11277 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11278 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11279 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11280 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011281 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11282 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11283 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11284 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11285 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11286 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011287
11288 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11289 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11290 the request.
11291
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011292 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11293 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011294 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011295
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011296 Example :
11297 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11298 # last 30 minutes
11299 backend pop
11300 mode tcp
11301 balance roundrobin
11302 stick store-request src
11303 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11304 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11305 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11306
11307 backend smtp
11308 mode tcp
11309 balance roundrobin
11310 stick match src table pop
11311 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11312 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11313
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011314 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011315 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011316
11317
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011318stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011319 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011320 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011321 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011323 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011324
11325 Arguments :
11326 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11327 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11328 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11329 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11330
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011331 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11332 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11333 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11334 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11335
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011336 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11337 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11338 instance.
11339
11340 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11341 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11342 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11343 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11344 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11345 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011346 to 32 characters.
11347
11348 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11349 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11350 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011351 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011352 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11353 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011354
11355 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011356 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11357 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11359 increase.
11360
11361 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011362 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11363 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11364 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011365
11366 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011367 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011368 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11369 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011370 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011371 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11372 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11373 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11374 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11375 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11376 parameter (see below).
11377
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011378 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11379 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11380 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11381 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11382 soft restart.
11383
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011384 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11385 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011386
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011387 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011388 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11389 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011390 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11391 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011392 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011393 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011394 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11395 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011396 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11397 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011398
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011399 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11400 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11401 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11402 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11403 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11404 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11405 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11406 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11407 token.
11408
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011409 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11410 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11411 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11412 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011413 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11414 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11415 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11416 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11417 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11418 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11419 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11420 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11421 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11422 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11423 types and their arguments.
11424
11425 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11426 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11427 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11428 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11429
11430 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11431 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11432 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011433 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011434
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011435 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11436 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11437 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011438 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011439 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011440 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011441
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011442 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11443 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11444 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11445 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11446
11447 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11448 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11449 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11450 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11451 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11452 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11453
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011454 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11455 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11456 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11457 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11458
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011459 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11460 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11461 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11462 they were received.
11463
11464 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11465 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11466 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11467 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11468 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11469
11470 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11471 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11472 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11473 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11474 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11475
11476 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11477 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11478 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11479
11480 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11481 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11482 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11483 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11484 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11485
11486 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11487 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11488 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11489 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11490 the client side.
11491
11492 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11493 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11494 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11495 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11496 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11497 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11498 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11499
11500 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11501 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11502 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11503 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11504 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11505 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011506 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011507
11508 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11509 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11510 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11511 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11512 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11513 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11514
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011515 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11516 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11517 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11518 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11519 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11520
11521 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11522 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11523 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11524 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11525 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11526 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11527
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011528 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011529 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011530 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11531 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11532
11533 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11534 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11535 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11536 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11537 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11538 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11539 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11540 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11541 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11542 recommended for better fairness.
11543
11544 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011545 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011546 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11547 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11548
11549 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11550 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11551 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11552 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11553 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11554 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11555 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11556 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11557 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11558 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011559
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011560 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11561 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011562 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11563 reference it.
11564
11565 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11566 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011567 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11568 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11569 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011570
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011571 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11572 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11573 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11574 something that can be ignored.
11575
11576 Example:
11577 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11578 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11579 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11580 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11581
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011582 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011583 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011584
11585
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011586stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011587 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11589 no | no | yes | yes
11590
11591 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011592 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011593 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011594 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011595 server is selected.
11596
11597 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11598 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11599 the "stick-table" statement.
11600
11601 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11602 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11603 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11604 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11605
11606 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11607 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11608 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11609 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11610 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11611 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011612 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011613 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11614 rules.
11615
11616 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11617 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11618 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11619 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11620 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11621 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11622 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11623
11624 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11625 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11626 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11627 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11628
11629 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11630 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11631 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11632 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11633 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11634 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011635 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11636 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11637 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11638 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11639 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11640 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11641 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11642 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11643 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011644
11645 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11646
11647 Example :
11648 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11649 backend https
11650 mode tcp
11651 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011652 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011653 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011654
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011655 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11656 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011657
11658 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11659 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11660 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11661
11662 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11663 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011664
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011665 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11666 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11667 # at offset 44.
11668
11669 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011670 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011671
11672 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011673 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011674
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011675 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11676 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11677
11678 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11679 extraction.
11680
11681
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011682tcp-check comment <string>
11683 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11684 it fails.
11685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11686 yes | no | yes | yes
11687
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011688 Arguments :
11689 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11690 rule fails.
11691
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011692 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11693 user-friendly error reporting.
11694
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011695 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11696 "tcp-check expect".
11697
11698
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011699tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11700 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011701 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011702 Opens a new connection
11703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011704 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011705
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011706 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011707 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11708
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011709 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011710 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011711
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011712 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011713 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11714 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011715 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011716
11717 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011718
11719 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11720
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011721 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11722
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011723 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11724
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011725 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11726
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011727 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11728 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11729 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11730 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11731
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011732 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11733 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11734 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11735 haproxy -vv.
11736
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011737 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011738
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011739 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11740 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11741 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11742
11743 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11744 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11745 of the sequence.
11746
11747 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11748 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11749 do.
11750
11751 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11752 unset-var or comment rules.
11753
11754 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011755 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11756 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11757 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11758 option tcp-check
11759 tcp-check connect
11760 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11761 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11762 tcp-check send \r\n
11763 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11764 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11765 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11766 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11767 tcp-check send \r\n
11768 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11769 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11770
11771 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11772 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011773 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011774 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11775 tcp-check connect port 143
11776 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11777 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11778
11779 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11780
11781
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011782tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011783 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011784 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011785 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011788 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011789
11790 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011791 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11792
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011793 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11794 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11795 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11796 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11797 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11798 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11799 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11800 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11801 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11802 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11803
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011804 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011805 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11806 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011807 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11808 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11809 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11810
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011811 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11812 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11813 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011814 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11815 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011816 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11817 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011818 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11819 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011820 By default "L7OK" is used.
11821
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011822 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11823 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011824 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11825 supported :
11826 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11827 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011828 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11829 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11830 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11831 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11832 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011833
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011834 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011835 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011836 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11837 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11838 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11839 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011840 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11841
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011842 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11843 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11844 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11845 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11846
11847 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11848 informational message reported in logs if an error
11849 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11850 log-format string.
11851
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011852 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11853 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11854 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11855 followed by some converters.
11856
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011857 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11858 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11859 with the usual backslash ('\').
11860 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011861 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011862 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11863 used upper or lower case.
11864
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011865 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11866
11867 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11868 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11869 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11870 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11871 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11872 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11873 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11874 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11875
11876 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11877 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11878 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11879 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11880 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11881 expression.
11882
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011883 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11884 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11885 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11886 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11887 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11888 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11889
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011890 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11891 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11892 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11893 this exact hexadecimal string.
11894 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11895
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011896 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11897 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11898 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11899 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11900 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11901 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11902 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11903 size.
11904
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011905 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11906 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11907 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11908 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11909 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11910 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11911 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11912 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11913 in a binary string before matching the response's
11914 buffer.
11915
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011916 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011917 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011918 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11919 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11920 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11921 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11922 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11923 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11924 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11925 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11926 the null character.
11927
11928 Examples :
11929 # perform a POP check
11930 option tcp-check
11931 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11932
11933 # perform an IMAP check
11934 option tcp-check
11935 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11936
11937 # look for the redis master server
11938 option tcp-check
11939 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011940 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011941 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11942 tcp-check expect string role:master
11943 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11944 tcp-check expect string +OK
11945
11946
11947 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011948 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011949
11950
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011951tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11952tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11953 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11954 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011956 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011957
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011958 Arguments :
11959 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11960
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011961 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11962 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011963
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011964 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11965 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011966
11967 Examples :
11968 # look for the redis master server
11969 option tcp-check
11970 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11971 tcp-check expect string role:master
11972
11973 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011974 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011975
11976
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011977tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11978tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11979 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11980 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011982 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011983
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011984 Arguments :
11985 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011986
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011987 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11988 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011989
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011990 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11991 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11992 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011993
11994 Examples :
11995 # redis check in binary
11996 option tcp-check
11997 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11998 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11999
12000
12001 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012002 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012003
12004
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012005tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012006 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012008 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012009
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012010 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012011 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12012 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12013 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12014 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12015 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12016 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12017 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12018 and '-'.
12019
12020 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12021
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012022 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012023 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12024
12025
12026tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012027 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012029 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012030
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012031 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012032 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12033 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12034 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12035 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12036 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12037 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12038 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12039 and '-'.
12040
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012041 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012042 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12043
12044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012045tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12046 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12048 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012049 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012050 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12051 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012053 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012054
12055 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12056 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012057 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12058 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12059 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12060 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12061 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12062 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012064 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12065 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12066 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12067 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012068
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012069 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012070 - accept :
12071 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12072 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12073 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012075 - reject :
12076 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12077 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12078 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12079 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12080 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12081 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12082 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12083 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12084 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12085 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12086 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012087 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012088
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012089 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12090 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12091 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12092 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12093 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12094 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12095 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12096 hosts.
12097
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012098 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12099 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12100 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12101 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12102 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12103 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12104 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12105 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12106
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012107 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12108 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12109 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12110 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12111 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12112 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12113 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12114 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12115 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012116 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12117 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012118
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012119 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012120 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012121 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12122 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12123 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012124 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012125 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012126 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12127 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12128 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12129 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12130 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12131 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12132 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012134 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012135 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012136 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012137 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012138 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12139 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12140 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012142 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12143 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12144 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12145 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012147 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12148 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12149 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12150 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12151 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012152 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12153 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12154 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12155 layer7 information is extracted.
12156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012157 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12158 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12159 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12160 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12161 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012162
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012163 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12164 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12165 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12166 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12167
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012168 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12169 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12170 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12171 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12172
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012173 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12174 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12175 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12176 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12177 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012178
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012179 - set-src <expr> :
12180 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12181 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12182 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012183 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012185 Arguments:
12186 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12187 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012188
12189 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012190 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12191
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012192 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12193 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012194
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012195 - set-src-port <expr> :
12196 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12197 expression.
12198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012199 Arguments:
12200 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12201 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012202
12203 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012204 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12205
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012206 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12207 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12208 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012209
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012210 - set-dst <expr> :
12211 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12212 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12213 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12214 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12215 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12216
12217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12218 followed by some converters.
12219
12220 Example:
12221
12222 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12223 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12224
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012225 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12226 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12227
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012228 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12229 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12230 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12231 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12232
12233
12234 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12235 followed by some converters.
12236
12237 Example:
12238
12239 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12240
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012241 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12242 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12243 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12244
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012245 - "silent-drop" :
12246 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012247 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012248 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12249 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12250 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12251 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12252 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012253 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12254 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012255 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12256 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012257 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012258 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12259 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12260 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12261 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012263 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12264 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12265 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012267 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12268 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12269 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012271 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012272 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012273 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012275 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12276 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12277 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012280 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12281 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012282
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012283 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12284
12285 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12286
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012287 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12288
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012289 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012290
12291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012292tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12293 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012295 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012296 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012297 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12298 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012299
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012300 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012301
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012302 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012303 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12304 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012305 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12306 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012308 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12309 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12310 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12311 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012312 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012313 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012314 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12315 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12316 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12317 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012318 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012319 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012321 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12322 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12323 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12324 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012325
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012326 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012327 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012328 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012329 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12330 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012331 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012332 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012333 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012334 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012335 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012336 - set-dst <expr>
12337 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012338 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012339 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012340 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012341 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012342 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012343 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012344
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012345 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12346 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012347 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12348 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012349
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012350 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12351 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12352 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12353 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12354 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12355 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012357 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012358 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12359 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012360
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012361 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12362 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12363 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12364 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12365 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12366 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012368 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012369 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12370 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12371 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12372 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12373 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12374 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12375 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12376 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12377 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12378 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012379
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012380 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012381 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12382 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12383 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012384
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012385 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12386 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12387
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012388 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012389 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12390 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012391
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012392 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12393 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012394 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012395 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12396 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012397 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012398 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012399 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012400 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12401 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012402 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012403 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12404 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012405
12406 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12407 followed by some converters.
12408
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012409 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012410 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12411 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12412 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12413 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12414 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12415 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012416 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012417 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12418 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12419
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012420 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12421
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012422 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12423 <var-name>.
12424
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012425 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12426 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12427 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12428 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12429 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12430
12431 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12432 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12433 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12434 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12435 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12436 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12437 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12438 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12439 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12440 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12441 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12442
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012443 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12444 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12445 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12446 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12447 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12448
12449 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12450
12451 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12452
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012453 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12454 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12455 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12456 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12457 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12458 evaluated.
12459
12460 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012461 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012462
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012463 Example:
12464
12465 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012466 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012467
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012468 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012469 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012470 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012471 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12472 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012473 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012474 tcp-request content reject
12475
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012476 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12477 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12478 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12479 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12480 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12481 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12482 ...
12483 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12484
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012485 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012486 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12487 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012488 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012489 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012490
12491 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12492 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012493 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012494 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012495 tcp-request content reject
12496
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012497 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012498 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012499 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012500 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012501 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12502 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012503
12504 Example:
12505 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12506 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012507 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012509 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012510 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012511
12512 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012513 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012514 # protecting all our sites
12515 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012516 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12517 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012518 ...
12519 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12520
12521 backend http_dynamic
12522 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012523 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012524 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012525 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012526 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012527 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012528 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012530 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012531
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012532 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12533 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012534
12535
12536tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12537 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012539 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012540 Arguments :
12541 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12542 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12543 as explained at the top of this document.
12544
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012545 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012546 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12547 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12548 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12549 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12550
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012551 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12552 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12553 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12554 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12555
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012556 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012557 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012558 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012559 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012560 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012561 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12562 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12563 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012564
12565 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12566 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12567 it pass through unaffected.
12568
12569 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12570 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12571 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012572 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012573 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12574 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012575 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12576 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12577 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012578
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012579 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012580 "timeout client".
12581
12582
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012583tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12584 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12586 no | no | yes | yes
12587 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012588 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12589 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012590
12591 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012593 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012594 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12595 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012596 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12597 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012598
12599 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12600
12601 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12602 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12603 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12604 inserted.
12605
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012606 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012607 - accept :
12608 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12609 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12610 the rules evaluation.
12611
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012612 - close :
12613 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12614 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12615 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12616 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12617 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12618 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012619 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012620 protocols.
12621
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012622 - reject :
12623 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12624 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012625 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012626
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012627 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012628 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012629
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012630 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12631 Unsets a variable.
12632
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012633 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12634 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12635 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12636 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12637
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012638 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12639 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12640 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12641 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12642
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012643 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12644 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12645 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12646 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12647 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012648
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012649 - "silent-drop" :
12650 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012651 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012652 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12653 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12654 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12655 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12656 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012657 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12658 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012659 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12660 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012661 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012662 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12663 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12664 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12665 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12666
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012667 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12668 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12669
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012670 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12671 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12672 for changing the default action to a reject.
12673
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012674 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12675 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12676 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12677 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012678 period.
12679
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012680 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12681 declared inline.
12682
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012683 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12684 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012685 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012686 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12687 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012688 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012689 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012690 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012691 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12692 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012694 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12695 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012696
12697 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12698 followed by some converters.
12699
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012700 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12701 <var-name>.
12702
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012703 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12704 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12705 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12706 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12707 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12708
12709 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12710
12711 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12712
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012713 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12714
12715 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12716
12717
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012718tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12719 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12721 no | yes | yes | no
12722 Arguments :
12723 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12724 below.
12725
12726 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12727
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012728 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012729 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12730 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12731 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12732 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12733 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12734 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12735 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012737 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12738 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12739 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12740 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12741 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12742 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12743 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12744 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12745 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12746 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12747 instead.
12748
12749 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12750 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12751 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12752 rules which may be inserted.
12753
12754 Several types of actions are supported :
12755 - accept : the request is accepted
12756 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12757 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12758 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012759 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012760 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012761 - set-dst <expr>
12762 - set-dst-port <expr>
12763 - set-src <expr>
12764 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012765 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012766 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012767 - silent-drop
12768
12769 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12770 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12771 sections for a complete description.
12772
12773 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12774 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12775 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12776
12777 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12778 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12779 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12780 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12781 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12782
12783 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12784 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12785
12786 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12787 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12788 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12789
12790 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12791 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12792 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12793
12794 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12795 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12796 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12797
12798 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12799 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12800 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12801
12802 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12803
12804 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12805
12806
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012807tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12808 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12810 no | no | yes | yes
12811 Arguments :
12812 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12814 as explained at the top of this document.
12815
12816 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12817
12818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012819timeout check <timeout>
12820 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12821 established.
12822
12823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12824 yes | no | yes | yes
12825 Arguments:
12826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12828 as explained at the top of this document.
12829
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012830 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012831 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012832 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012833 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012834 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12835 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12836 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012837
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012838 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012839 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12840
12841 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12842 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012843 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012844
12845 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12846 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12847 forget about it.
12848
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012849 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12850 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012851
12852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012853timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012854 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12856 yes | yes | yes | no
12857 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12860 as explained at the top of this document.
12861
12862 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12863 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12864 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012865 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12866 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12867 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12868 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012869 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12870 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12871 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012872 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012873 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012874 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12875 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012876 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12877 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878
12879 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12880 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12881 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12882 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012883 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012884 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12885
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012886 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012887
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012888
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012889timeout client-fin <timeout>
12890 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12892 yes | yes | yes | no
12893 Arguments :
12894 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12895 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12896 as explained at the top of this document.
12897
12898 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12899 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12900 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12901 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12902 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12903 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12904 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012905 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12906 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12907 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012908
12909 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12910 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12911 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12912
12913 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12914
12915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012916timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012917 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12919 yes | no | yes | yes
12920 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012921 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012922 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12923 as explained at the top of this document.
12924
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012925 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012926 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012927 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012928 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012929 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12930 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012931
12932 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12933 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12934 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12935 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012936 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012937 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12938
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012939 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012941
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012942timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12943 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12945 yes | yes | yes | yes
12946 Arguments :
12947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12949 as explained at the top of this document.
12950
12951 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12952 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12953 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12954 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12955 once the request has started to present itself.
12956
12957 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12958 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12959 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12960 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12961 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12962
12963 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12964 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12965 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12966 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12967
12968 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12969 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012970 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012971 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12972 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012973 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012974
12975 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12976 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12977 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12978 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12979
12980 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12981
12982
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012983timeout http-request <timeout>
12984 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012986 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012987 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012988 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012989 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12990 as explained at the top of this document.
12991
12992 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12993 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12994 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12995 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12996 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12997 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12998 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012999 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13000 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13001 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13002 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013004 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13005 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013006
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013007 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13008 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13009 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13010 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13011 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013012 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013013
13014 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13015 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013016 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013017 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13018 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13019
13020 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013021 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13022 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13023 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013024
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013025 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013026 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013027
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013028
13029timeout queue <timeout>
13030 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13032 yes | no | yes | yes
13033 Arguments :
13034 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13035 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13036 as explained at the top of this document.
13037
13038 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13039 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13040 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13041 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13042 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13043
13044 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13045 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13046 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13047 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13048
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013049 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013050
13051
13052timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013053 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13055 yes | no | yes | yes
13056 Arguments :
13057 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13058 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13059 as explained at the top of this document.
13060
13061 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13062 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13063 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13064 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13065 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13066 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13067 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13068
13069 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13070 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13071 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13072 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13073 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013074 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013075 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013076 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13077 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013078 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13079 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013080
13081 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13082 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13083 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13084 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013085 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013086 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13087
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013088 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013089
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013090
13091timeout server-fin <timeout>
13092 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13094 yes | no | yes | yes
13095 Arguments :
13096 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13097 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13098 as explained at the top of this document.
13099
13100 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13101 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13102 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13103 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13104 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13105 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13106 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13107 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13108 situations, it should not be needed.
13109
13110 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13111 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13112 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13113
13114 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13115
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013116
13117timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013118 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13120 yes | yes | yes | yes
13121 Arguments :
13122 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13124 as explained at the top of this document.
13125
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013126 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13127 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13128 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013129
13130 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13131 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13132 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13133 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013134 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013135
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013136 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013137
13138
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013139timeout tunnel <timeout>
13140 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13142 yes | no | yes | yes
13143 Arguments :
13144 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13145 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13146 as explained at the top of this document.
13147
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013148 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013149 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13150 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13151 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013152 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13153 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013154 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13155 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13156 specified.
13157
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013158 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13159 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13160 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13161 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13162 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13163 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13164 state.
13165
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013166 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13167 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13168 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13169 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013170 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013171
13172 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13173 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13174 forget about it.
13175
13176 Example :
13177 defaults http
13178 option http-server-close
13179 timeout connect 5s
13180 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013181 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013182 timeout server 30s
13183 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13184
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013185 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013186
13187
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013188transparent (deprecated)
13189 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013191 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013192 Arguments : none
13193
13194 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13195 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13196 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13197 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13198 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13199 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13200 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13201 appropriate server.
13202
13203 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13204
13205 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13206 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13207
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013208 See also: "option transparent"
13209
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013210unique-id-format <string>
13211 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13213 yes | yes | yes | no
13214 Arguments :
13215 <string> is a log-format string.
13216
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013217 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13218 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13219 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13220 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013221
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013222 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013223 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013224 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13225 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13226 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13227 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13228 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13229 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013230
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013231 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13232 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013233
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013234 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013235
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013236 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013237
13238 will generate:
13239
13240 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13241
13242 See also: "unique-id-header"
13243
13244unique-id-header <name>
13245 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13247 yes | yes | yes | no
13248 Arguments :
13249 <name> is the name of the header.
13250
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013251 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13252 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013253
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013254 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013255
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013256 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013257 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13258
13259 will generate:
13260
13261 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13262
13263 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013264
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013265use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013266 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13268 no | yes | yes | no
13269 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013270 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13271 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013272
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013273 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13274 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013275
13276 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13277 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13278 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013279 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013281 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13282 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013283
13284 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13285 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13286 assign the backend.
13287
13288 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13289 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13290 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13291 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13292 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13293 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13294
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013295 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013296 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013297 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13298 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13299 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13300
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013301 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13302 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13303 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13304 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13305 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13306 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13307 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13308 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13309 cannot be forced from the request.
13310
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013311 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013312 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13313 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13314
13315 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13316 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013317
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013318use-fcgi-app <name>
13319 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13321 no | no | yes | yes
13322 Arguments :
13323 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13324
13325 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013326
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013327use-server <server> if <condition>
13328use-server <server> unless <condition>
13329 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13331 no | no | yes | yes
13332 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013333 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13334 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013335
13336 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13337
13338 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13339 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13340 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13341
13342 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13343 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13344 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13345 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13346 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13347 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13348 matches will assign the server.
13349
13350 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13351 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13352 with the next rules until one matches.
13353
13354 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13355 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13356 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13357 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13358
13359 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13360 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13361 stripped.
13362
13363 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13364 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013365 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013366 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013367 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013368
13369 Example :
13370 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013371 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013372 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013373 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013374 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013375 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013376 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013377 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13378 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13379
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013380 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13381 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13382 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13383 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013384 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013385 and we fall back to load balancing.
13386
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013387 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013388
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013389
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133905. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013391--------------------------
13392
13393The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13394depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13395settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13396written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13397described in this section.
13398
13399
134005.1. Bind options
13401-----------------
13402
13403The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13404as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13405no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13406parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13407while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13408provided immediately after the setting name.
13409
13410The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13411
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013412accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13413 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13414 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13415 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13416 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13417 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13418 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13419 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13420 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13421 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013422 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13423 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13424 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013425
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013426accept-proxy
13427 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013428 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13429 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013430 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13431 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13432 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13433 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013434 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013435 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13436 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013437 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13438 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013439
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013440allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013441 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013442 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013443 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013444 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13445 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013446
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013447alpn <protocols>
13448 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13449 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13450 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013451 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013452 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013453 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13454 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13455 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13456 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13457 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13458 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13459 preference, like below :
13460
13461 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013462
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013463backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013464 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013465 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13466
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013467curves <curves>
13468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13469 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13470 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13471 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13472 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13473 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13474
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013475ecdhe <named curve>
13476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013477 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13478 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013479
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013480ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013481 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13482 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13483 client's certificate.
13484
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013485ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13487 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13488 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13489 error is ignored.
13490
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013491ca-sign-file <cafile>
13492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13493 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13494 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13495 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13496 'generate-certificates' for details.
13497
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013498ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13500 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13501 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13502 'generate-certificates' for details.
13503
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013504ca-verify-file <cafile>
13505 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13506 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13507 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13508 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13509 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13510
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013511ciphers <ciphers>
13512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13513 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013514 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013515 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013516 information and recommendations see e.g.
13517 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13518 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13519 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13520
13521ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13523 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13524 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13525 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013526 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13527 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013528
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013529crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13531 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013532 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13533 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013534
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013535crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13537 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13538 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13539 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13540 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013541 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13542 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013543
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013544 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13545 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13546
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013547 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13548 are loaded.
13549
13550 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013551 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13552 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13553 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13554 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13555 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13556 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13557 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013558 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013559
13560 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13561 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13562 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13563 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013564 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13565 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013566
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013567 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013568
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013569 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013570 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013571 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13572 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013573 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13574 clients).
13575
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013576 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013577 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13578 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13579 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13580 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13581 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13582 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13583 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13584 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13585 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13586 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13587 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13588 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13589
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013590 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013591 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13592 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13593 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13594 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13595
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013596 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13597 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13598 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13599 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013600
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013601 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13602 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13603 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013604
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013605crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013607 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013608 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013609 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013610
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013611crt-list <file>
13612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013613 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13614 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013615
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013616 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13617
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013618 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13619 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13620 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13621 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13622 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013623
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013624 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013625 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13626 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13627 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13628 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13629 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013630 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13631 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13632 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013633
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013634 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13635 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13636 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013637
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013638 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13639
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013640 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013641 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013642 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13643 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13644 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13645 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13646 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13647 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013648
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013649 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013650 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013651 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013652 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013653 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013654 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013655
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013656defer-accept
13657 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13658 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13659 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013661 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13662 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13663 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13664 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13665 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13666 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13667 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13668
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013669expose-fd listeners
13670 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13671 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013672 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13673 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013674 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013675
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013676force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013677 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013678 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013679 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013680 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013681
13682force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013683 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013684 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013686
13687force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013688 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013689 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013690 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013691
13692force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013693 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013694 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013695 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013696
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013697force-tlsv13
13698 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13699 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013700 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013701
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013702generate-certificates
13703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13704 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13705 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13706 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13707 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13708 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13709 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13710 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13711 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13712 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13713 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13714
13715 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13716 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013717 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013718 certificate is used many times.
13719
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013720gid <gid>
13721 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13722 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13723 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13724 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13725 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13726
13727group <group>
13728 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13729 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13730 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13731 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13732 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13733
13734id <id>
13735 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13736 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13737 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13738 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13739
13740interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013741 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13742 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13743 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13744 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13745 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13746 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013747 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13748 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13749 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13750 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13751 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13752 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013753
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013754level <level>
13755 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13756 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13757 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013758 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013759 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13760 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13761 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013762 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013763 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013764 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013765 all counters).
13766
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013767severity-output <format>
13768 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13769 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13770 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13771 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13772 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13773 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13774 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13775 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13776 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13777 rfc5424 convention.
13778
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013779maxconn <maxconn>
13780 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13781 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13782 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13783 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13784 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13785 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13786 eat all memory.
13787
13788mode <mode>
13789 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13790 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13791 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13792 UNIX sockets.
13793
13794mss <maxseg>
13795 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13796 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13797 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13798 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13799 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13800 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13801 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13802 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13803 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13804 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13805 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13806
13807name <name>
13808 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13809 page.
13810
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013811namespace <name>
13812 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13813 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13814 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13815 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13816
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013817nice <nice>
13818 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13819 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13820 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13821 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13822 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13823 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13824 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13825 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13826 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13827 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13828 one for an RDP socket.
13829
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013830no-ca-names
13831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13832 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013833 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013834
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013835no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013837 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013838 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013839 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013840 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13841 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013842
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013843no-tls-tickets
13844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13845 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13846 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013847 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13848 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013849 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13850 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13851 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013852
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013853no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013855 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013856 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013857 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013858 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13859 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013860
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013861no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013863 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013864 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013865 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013866 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13867 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013868
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013869no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013871 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013872 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013873 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013874 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13875 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013876
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013877no-tlsv13
13878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13879 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13880 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13881 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013882 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13883 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013884
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013885npn <protocols>
13886 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13887 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13888 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013889 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013890 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013891 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13892 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13893 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13894 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13895 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013896
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013897prefer-client-ciphers
13898 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13899 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13900 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013901 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13902 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13903 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013904
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013905process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013906 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013907 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013908 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013909 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13910 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13911 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13912 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013914 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13915 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13916 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13917 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13918 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013919
13920 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13921
13922 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13923 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13924 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13925 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13926 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13927 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13928 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13929 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013930
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013931proto <name>
13932 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13933 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13934 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013935 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13936 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13937
13938 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13939 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13940 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13941 also reported (flag=HTX).
13942
13943 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13944 a bind line :
13945
13946 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13947 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13948 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13949
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013950 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013951 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013952 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013953 h2" on the bind line.
13954
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013955ssl
13956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013957 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013958 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13959 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013960 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13961 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013962
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013963ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13964 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013965 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13966 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13967 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013968 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13969
13970ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013971 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13972 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13973 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13974 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013975
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013976strict-sni
13977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13978 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13979 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13980 See the "crt" option for more information.
13981
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013982tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013983 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013984 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013985 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013986 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013987 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13988 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13989 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13990 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13991 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13992 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13993 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13994
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013995tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013996 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013997 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13998 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13999 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14000 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14001 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14002 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14003 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014004 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14005 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14006 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014007
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014008tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14009 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014010 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14011 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14012 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14013 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14014 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14015 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14016 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14017 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14018 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14019 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014020 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14021 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14022
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014023transparent
14024 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14025 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14026 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14027 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14028 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14029 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14030 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14031 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14032 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14033 so check for support with your vendor.
14034
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014035v4v6
14036 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14037 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14038 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14039 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014040 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014041
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014042v6only
14043 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14044 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14045 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014046 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14047 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014048
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014049uid <uid>
14050 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14051 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14052 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14053 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14054 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14055
14056user <user>
14057 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14058 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14059 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14060 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14061 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14062
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014063verify [none|optional|required]
14064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14065 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14066 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14067 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14068 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014069 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14070 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14071 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14072 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014073
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140745.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014075------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014077The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14078which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14079arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14080settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14081after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14082Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14083address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014085 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014086 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014087
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014088Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14089keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14090
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014091The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014092
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014093addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014094 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014095 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14096 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14097 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14098 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14099 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014100
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014101agent-check
14102 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014103 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014104 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14105 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14106 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014107
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014108 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014109 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014110 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014111 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14112 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014113
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014114 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14115 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14116 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14117 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14118 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014119
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014120 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014121 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014122
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014123 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14124 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14125 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014126
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014127 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14128 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14129 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014130
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014131 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014132 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14133 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14134 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14135 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014136 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014137 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014138
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014139 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14140 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014141
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014142 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14143 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14144 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14145 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14146 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14147 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14148 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14149 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14150 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014151
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014152 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14153 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014154 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14155 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14156 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014157 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014158
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014159 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014160 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014161
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014162agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014163 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014164 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14165 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14166 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14167 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14168
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014169agent-inter <delay>
14170 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14171 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14172
14173 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14174 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14175 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14176 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14177 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14178 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14179 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14180 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14181 of backends use the same servers.
14182
14183 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14184
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014185agent-addr <addr>
14186 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14187
14188 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014189 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014190 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14191 hostname, it will be resolved.
14192
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014193agent-port <port>
14194 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14195
14196 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14197
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014198allow-0rtt
14199 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014200 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14201 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014202
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014203alpn <protocols>
14204 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14205 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14206 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014207 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014208 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14209 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14210 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14211 now obsolete NPN extension.
14212 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14213 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14214
14215 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14216
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014217 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014219backup
14220 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14221 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14222 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14223 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014224 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14225 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014226
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014227ca-file <cafile>
14228 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14229 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14230 server's certificate.
14231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014232check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014233 This option enables health checks on a server:
14234 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14235 considered available.
14236 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14237 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14238 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14239 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14240 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14241 set.
14242 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14243 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14244 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14245 exchanges succeed.
14246
14247 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14248 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14249 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14250 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14251 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014252 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014253 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14254
14255 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14256 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14257
14258 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14259 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14260
14261 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14262 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14263 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14264 available.
14265
14266 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14267 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14268 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14269
14270 Example:
14271 # simple tcp check
14272 backend foo
14273 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14274 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14275 backend foo
14276 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14277 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14278 backend foo
14279 option tcp-check
14280 tcp-check connect
14281 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014282
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014283check-send-proxy
14284 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14285 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14286 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14287 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14288 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14289 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14290 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14291
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014292check-alpn <protocols>
14293 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14294 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14295 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14296
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014297check-proto <name>
14298 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14299 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14300 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014301 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14302 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14303
14304 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14305 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14306 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14307 also reported (flag=HTX).
14308
14309 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14310 directive on a server line:
14311
14312 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14313 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14314 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14315 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14316
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014317 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014318 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14319 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14320
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014321check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014322 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014323 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14324 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014325
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014326check-ssl
14327 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14328 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14329 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14330 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014331 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014332 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14333 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014334 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014335 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14336 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014337
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014338check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014339 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014340 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14341 for normal traffic.
14342
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014343ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14345 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14346 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014347 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14348 information and recommendations see e.g.
14349 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14350 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14351 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014352
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014353ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14354 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14355 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14356 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14357 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014358 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14359 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14360 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014362cookie <value>
14363 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14364 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14365 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14366 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14367 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14368 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14369 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14370
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014371crl-file <crlfile>
14372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14373 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14374 to verify server's certificate.
14375
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014376crt <cert>
14377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14378 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14379 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14380 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14381 certificate request.
14382
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014383 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14384 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14385 option is set accordingly).
14386
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014387disabled
14388 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14389 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14390 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14391 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14392 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014393 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014394
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014395enabled
14396 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14397 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14398 default value.
14399 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14400 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014402error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014403 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14404 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14405 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014407 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014409fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014410 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14411 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14412 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14413
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014414force-sslv3
14415 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14416 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014417 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014418 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014419
14420force-tlsv10
14421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014422 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014423 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014424
14425force-tlsv11
14426 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014427 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014428 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014429
14430force-tlsv12
14431 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014432 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014433 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014434
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014435force-tlsv13
14436 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14437 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014438 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014440id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014441 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14442 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14443 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014444
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014445init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14446 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14447 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014448 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014449 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14450 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14451 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14452 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14453 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14454 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14455 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14456 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14457 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014458 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014459 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14460 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14461 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14462 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14463 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14464 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014465 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014466
14467 Example:
14468 defaults
14469 # never fail on address resolution
14470 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014472inter <delay>
14473fastinter <delay>
14474downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014475 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14476 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14477 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14478 between checks depending on the server state :
14479
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014480 Server state | Interval used
14481 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14482 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14483 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14484 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14485 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14486 or yet unchecked. |
14487 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14488 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14489 | "inter" otherwise.
14490 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014492 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14493 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14494 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14495 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014496 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14497 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14498 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14499 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14500 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014501
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014502log-proto <logproto>
14503 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14504 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14505 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14506 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014508maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014509 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14510 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014511 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14512 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014513 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14514 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14515 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14516 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14517
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014518 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14519 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14520 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14521 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14522 than 50 concurrent requests.
14523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014524maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014525 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14526 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14527 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14528 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014529 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14530 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14531 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14532 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14533 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14534 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14535 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014536
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014537max-reuse <count>
14538 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14539 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14540 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14541 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14542 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14543 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14544 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14545 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014547minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014548 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14549 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14550 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14551 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14552 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14553 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014554 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014555 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014556
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014557namespace <name>
14558 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14559 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14560 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14561 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14562
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014563no-agent-check
14564 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14565 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14566 default value.
14567 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14568 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14569
14570no-backup
14571 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14572 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14573 default value.
14574 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14575 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14576
14577no-check
14578 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14579 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14580 default value.
14581 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14582 "default-server" "check" setting.
14583
14584no-check-ssl
14585 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14586 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14587 default value.
14588 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14589 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14590
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014591no-send-proxy
14592 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14593 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14594 default value.
14595 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14596 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14597
14598no-send-proxy-v2
14599 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14600 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14601 default value.
14602 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14603 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14604
14605no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14606 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14607 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14608 default value.
14609 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14610 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14611
14612no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14613 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14614 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14615 default value.
14616 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14617 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14618
14619no-ssl
14620 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14621 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14622 default value.
14623 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14624 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14625
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014626 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14627 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14628 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14629
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014630no-ssl-reuse
14631 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14632 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14633 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14634 and for paranoid users.
14635
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014636no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014637 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14638 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014639 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014640
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014641 Supported in default-server: No
14642
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014643no-tls-tickets
14644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14645 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14646 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014647 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14648 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014649 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14650 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14651 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014652 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014653
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014654no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014655 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014656 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14657 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014658 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14659 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014660 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014661
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014662 Supported in default-server: No
14663
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014664no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014665 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014666 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14667 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014668 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14669 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014670 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014671
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014672 Supported in default-server: No
14673
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014674no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014675 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014676 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14677 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014678 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14679 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014680 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014681
14682 Supported in default-server: No
14683
14684no-tlsv13
14685 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14686 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14687 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14688 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14689 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014690 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014691
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014692 Supported in default-server: No
14693
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014694no-verifyhost
14695 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14696 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14697 default value.
14698 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14699 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014700
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014701no-tfo
14702 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14703 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14704 default value.
14705 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14706 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14707
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014708non-stick
14709 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14710 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14711 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14712
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014713npn <protocols>
14714 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14715 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14716 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014717 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014718 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14719 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14720 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014722observe <mode>
14723 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14724 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14725 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14726 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14727 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14728 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014729 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014730
14731 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014733on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014734 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14735 Currently, four modes are available:
14736 - fastinter: force fastinter
14737 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14738 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14739 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14740 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14741
14742 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14743
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014744on-marked-down <action>
14745 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14746 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014747 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14748 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14749 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14750 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14751 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14752 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14753 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14754 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014755
14756 Actions are disabled by default
14757
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014758on-marked-up <action>
14759 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14760 Currently one action is available:
14761 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14762 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14763 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14764 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014765 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14766 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014767 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14768 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14769
14770 Actions are disabled by default
14771
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014772pool-low-conn <max>
14773 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14774 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14775 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14776 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14777 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14778 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14779 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14780 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14781 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14782 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014783 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14784 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14785 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14786 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014787
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014788pool-max-conn <max>
14789 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14790 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14791 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14792 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14793 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14794 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14795
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014796pool-purge-delay <delay>
14797 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014798 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014799 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014801port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014802 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014803 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14804 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14805 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14806 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14807 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014808
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014809proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014810 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14811 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14812 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014813 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14814 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14815
14816 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14817 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14818 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14819 also reported (flag=HTX).
14820
14821 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14822 a server line :
14823
14824 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14825 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14826 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14827 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14828
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014829 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014830 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14831
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014832 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014834redir <prefix>
14835 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14836 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14837 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14838 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14839 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14840 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14841 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14842 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014843 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014844 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014845 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14846 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14847 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14848 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14849
14850 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014852rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014853 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14854 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14855 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14856
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014857resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14858 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14859 server.
14860
14861 Available options:
14862
14863 * allow-dup-ip
14864 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14865 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14866 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14867 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14868 For such case, simply enable this option.
14869 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14870
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014871 * ignore-weight
14872 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14873 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14874 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14875
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014876 * prevent-dup-ip
14877 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14878 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14879 same fqdn.
14880 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14881
14882 Example:
14883 backend b_myapp
14884 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14885 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14886 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14887
14888 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14889 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14890 it
14891 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14892 different address
14893
14894 Default value: not set
14895
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014896resolve-prefer <family>
14897 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14898 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14899 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14900 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14901
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014902 Default value: ipv6
14903
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014904 Example:
14905
14906 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014907
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014908resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014909 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014910 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014911 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014912 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14913 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014914 configured network, another address is selected.
14915
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014916 Example:
14917
14918 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014919
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014920resolvers <id>
14921 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14922 hostname.
14923
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014924 Example:
14925
14926 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014927
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014928 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014929
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014930send-proxy
14931 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14932 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14933 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14934 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014935 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14936 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14937 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14938 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014939 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014940 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14941 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14942 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14943 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14944 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014945 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14946 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014947
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014948send-proxy-v2
14949 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14950 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14951 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14952 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014953 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14954 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14955 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14956 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014957
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014958proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014959 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14960 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14961
14962 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14963 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14964 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14965 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14966 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14967 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14968 connection is supported).
14969 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14970 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14971 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14972 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14973 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14974 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14975 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014976
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014977send-proxy-v2-ssl
14978 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14979 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14980 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14981 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14982 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14983 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14984 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014985 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14986 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014987
14988send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14989 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14990 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14991 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14992 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14993 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14994 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14995 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14996 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014997 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14998 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015000slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015001 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15002 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15003 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15004 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15005 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15006 parameters :
15007
15008 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15009 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15010
15011 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15012 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15013 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15014 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15015
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015016 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015017 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15018 seen as failed.
15019
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015020sni <expression>
15021 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15022 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15023 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015024 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15025 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15026 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15027 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015028 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015029 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015030 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15031 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015032
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015033source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015034source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015035source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015036 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15037 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15038 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15039 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15040
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015041 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15042 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15043 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15044 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15045 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15046 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15047 server.
15048
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015049 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15050 specifying the source address without port(s).
15051
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015052ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015053 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15054 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15055 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15056 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15057 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15058 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015059 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15060 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015061
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015062ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15063 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15064 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15065 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15066
15067ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15068 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15069 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15070 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15071
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015072ssl-reuse
15073 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15074 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15075 default value.
15076 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15077 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15078
15079stick
15080 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15081 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15082 default value.
15083 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15084 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015085
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015086socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015087 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015088 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15089 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15090
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015091tcp-ut <delay>
15092 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015093 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015094 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015095 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015096 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15097 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15098 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15099 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15100 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15101 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15102 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15103 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15104 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15105
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015106tfo
15107 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15108 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15109 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15110 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015111 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015112 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015114track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015115 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15116 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15117 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15118 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015119 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15120
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015121tls-tickets
15122 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15123 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15124 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015125 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15126 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15127 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015128 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015129 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015130
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015131verify [none|required]
15132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015133 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015134 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15135 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015136 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015137 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15138 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15139 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15140 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15141 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15142 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15143 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15144 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015145
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015146verifyhost <hostname>
15147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015148 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15149 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15150 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15151 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15152 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15153 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15154 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15155 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015157weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015158 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15159 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15160 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015161 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15162 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15163 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15164 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15165 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15166 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015167
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015168ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15169 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15170 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15171 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15172
15173 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15174 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15175 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15176 server ALPN contains it.
15177
15178 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15179 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15180 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15181 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15182
15183 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15184 favor of the ALPN extension.
15185
15186 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015188
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151895.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15190-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015191
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015192HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15193using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015194configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015195This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15196can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15197workload.
15198This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15199resolution at run time.
15200Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15201carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15202
15203
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152045.3.1. Global overview
15205----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015206
15207As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15208different steps of the process life:
15209
15210 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15211 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15212 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15213
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015214 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15215 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015216
15217A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15218 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15219 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15220 resolution to know this new IP.
15221
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015222When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015223HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015224SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15225from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015226will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015227will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015228
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015229A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015230 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015231 first valid response.
15232
15233 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15234 servers return an error.
15235
15236
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152375.3.2. The resolvers section
15238----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015239
15240This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015241HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15242contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015243
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015244When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15245uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15246is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15247answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15248
15249When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015250used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015251
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015252 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15253 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15254 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015255
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015256 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15257 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015258
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015259 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015260 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15261 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015262
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015263For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15264following scenarios are possible:
15265
15266 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15267 ignored
15268
15269 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15270 applied
15271
15272 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15273 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15274
15275 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15276 retries the query with a new type
15277
15278 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15279 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015280
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015281As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015282a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015283<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015284
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015285
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015286resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015287 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015288
15289A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15290
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015291accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015292 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015293 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015294 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15295 by RFC 6891)
15296
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015297 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15298 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15299 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15300 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15301 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15302 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015303
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015304nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15305 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15306 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15307 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15308 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15309 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15310 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15311 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15312 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15313 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015314 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15315
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015316parse-resolv-conf
15317 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15318 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15319 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15320
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015321hold <status> <period>
15322 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15323 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015324 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015325 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015326 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15327 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15328 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15329
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015330 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015331
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015332resolve_retries <nb>
15333 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15334 giving up.
15335 Default value: 3
15336
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015337 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15338 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15339 type.
15340
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015341timeout <event> <time>
15342 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15343 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15344 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015345 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15346 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015347 Default value: 1s
15348 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015349 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015350 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015351 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15352 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15353
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015354 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015355
15356 resolvers mydns
15357 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15358 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015359 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015360 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015361 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015362 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015363 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015364 hold other 30s
15365 hold refused 30s
15366 hold nx 30s
15367 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015368 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015369 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015370
15371
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153726. Cache
15373---------
15374
15375HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15376(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15377RAM.
15378
15379The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15380this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15381
15382If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15383independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15384when we try to allocate a new one.
15385
15386The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15387
15388It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15389"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15390for more details.
15391
15392When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15393replaced by "<CACHE>".
15394
15395
153966.1. Limitation
15397----------------
15398
15399The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15400
15401- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015402- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15403 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15404 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015405- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15406- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015407- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15408 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15409 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015410- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15411 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015412- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15413 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15414 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015415
15416- If the request is not a GET
15417- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15418- If the request contains an Authorization header
15419
15420
154216.2. Setup
15422-----------
15423
15424To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15425the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15426
15427
154286.2.1. Cache section
15429---------------------
15430
15431cache <name>
15432 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15433 size of cache is mandatory.
15434
15435total-max-size <megabytes>
15436 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15437 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15438
15439max-object-size <bytes>
15440 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15441 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15442 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15443
15444max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015445 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015446 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15447 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15448 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15449 default.
15450
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015451process-vary <on/off>
15452 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015453 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15454 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15455 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015456 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015457
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015458max-secondary-entries <number>
15459 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15460 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15461 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15462
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015463
154646.2.2. Proxy section
15465---------------------
15466
15467http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15468 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15469 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15470 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15471 after this one.
15472
15473http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15474 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15475 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15476 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15477 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15478
15479
15480Example:
15481
15482 backend bck1
15483 mode http
15484
15485 http-request cache-use foobar
15486 http-response cache-store foobar
15487 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15488
15489 cache foobar
15490 total-max-size 4
15491 max-age 240
15492
15493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154947. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15495----------------------------------
15496
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015497HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15499The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15500these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15501but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15502data called patterns.
15503
15504
155057.1. ACL basics
15506---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015507
15508The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15509content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15510from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15511simple :
15512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015514 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15516 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15519adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015520
15521In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015524
15525This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15526Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15527and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015528an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15529conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15530as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15531are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015532
15533ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15534'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15535which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15536
15537There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15538performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15541specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15542this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015543methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15544ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545
15546Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15547 - boolean
15548 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15549 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15550 - string
15551 - data block
15552
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015553Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15554converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15555would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15556The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15557which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15558
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015559Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15560keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15561fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15562which are summarized in the table below :
15563
15564 +---------------------+-----------------+
15565 | Sample or converter | Default |
15566 | output type | matching method |
15567 +---------------------+-----------------+
15568 | boolean | bool |
15569 +---------------------+-----------------+
15570 | integer | int |
15571 +---------------------+-----------------+
15572 | ip | ip |
15573 +---------------------+-----------------+
15574 | string | str |
15575 +---------------------+-----------------+
15576 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15577 +---------------------+-----------------+
15578
15579Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15580matching method, see below.
15581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15583 - boolean
15584 - integer or integer range
15585 - IP address / network
15586 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15587 - regular expression
15588 - hex block
15589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015590The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15591
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015592 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15593 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015595 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015596 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015597 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015598 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15601read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15602if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15603lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15604will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15605beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015606a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15608exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15609
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015610The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15611parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15612ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15613a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15614check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15615
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015616The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15617socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15618file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15621loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15622
15623 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15624
15625In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15626the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15627case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15628as well.
15629
15630The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15631sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15632do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15633methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15634is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015635obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15637default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15638that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15639string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15640
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015641The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15642By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15643string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15644resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015645server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015646waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015647flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15648function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15651sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15652be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015653
15654 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15655 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15657 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15658 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15659 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015660
15661 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15662 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015664
15665 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015667
15668 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015670
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015671 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015672 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15673
15674 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15675 binary or string samples.
15676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15678 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15681 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15682 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15685 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15688 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15691 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15694 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015695 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15698 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15699 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015700
15701For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15702request, it is possible to do :
15703
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015704 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015705
15706In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15707buffer, one would use the following acl :
15708
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015709 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015710
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015711On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15712possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15713
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015714 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15717criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15718method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015719to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15720usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15721converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15722method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15723matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15725the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015728the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15729For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15732 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15733 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15734 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015735
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015736
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015737The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15738types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15739combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15740brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15741default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743 +-------------------------------------------------+
15744 | Input sample type |
15745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015746 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15748 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15749 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015750 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015752 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015754 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015756 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015758 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015760 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015761 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015762 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015764 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015766 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015768 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015770 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15772 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15773 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015774
15775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157767.1.1. Matching booleans
15777------------------------
15778
15779In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15780Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15781When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15782that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15783
15784Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15785return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15786"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15787
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157897.1.2. Matching integers
15790------------------------
15791
15792Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15793enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15794to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15795
15796Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15797matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15798lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015799
15800For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15801unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15802representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15803
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015804As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15805two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15806instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15807ranges and operators.
15808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015809For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015810operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15811Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15812of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015814Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015815
15816 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15817 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15818 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15819 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15820 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015822For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015823
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015824 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015825
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015826This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15827
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015828 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015829
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158317.1.3. Matching strings
15832-----------------------
15833
15834String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15835different forms :
15836
15837 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015838 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015839
15840 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015841 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842
15843 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15844 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15845
15846 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15847 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15848
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015849 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15850 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15851 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15852 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15853 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15854 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015856 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15857 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15858 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15859 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15860 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15861 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15862 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15863 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15864 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15865 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15866 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015867
15868String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15869exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15870characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15871string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15872to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015873before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015874
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015875Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15876(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15877Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15878
15879Example:
15880 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15881 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15882
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158847.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15885---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015886
15887Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15888they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15889possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15890passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15891the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015892the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15893match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015894
15895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158967.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15897-------------------------------------
15898
15899It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15900not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15901a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15902to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15903digits may be used upper or lower case.
15904
15905Example :
15906 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015907 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908
15909
159107.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15911---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015912
15913IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15914netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15915within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015916host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015917difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15918at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15919does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15920parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015921
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015922The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15923abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15924
15925 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15926 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15927 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15928 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15929 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15930 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15931 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15932 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15933
15934Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15935192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15936
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015937IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15938Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15939trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15940IPv6 patterns.
15941
15942HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15943following situations :
15944 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15945 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15946 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15947 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15948 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15949 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15950 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15951 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15952 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15953 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955
159567.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15957----------------------------------
15958
15959Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15960combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15961
15962 - AND (implicit)
15963 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15964 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015970Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15971indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15974"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15975requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15976is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15977
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015978 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015979 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15980 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15981 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982
15983To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15984and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15985
15986 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15987 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15988 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15989 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15990
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015991 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15993 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15994 use_backend www if host_www
15995
15996It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15997expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15998be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15999the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16000
16001 The following rule :
16002
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016003 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016004 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005
16006 Can also be written that way :
16007
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016008 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009
16010It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16011to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16012simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16013sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16014good use is the following :
16015
16016 With named ACLs :
16017
16018 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16019 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16020 monitor fail if site_dead
16021
16022 With anonymous ACLs :
16023
16024 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16025
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016026See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16027keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028
16029
160307.3. Fetching samples
16031---------------------
16032
16033Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16034against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16035sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16036ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16037of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16038available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16039
16040This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16041Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16042compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16043deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16044
16045The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16046matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16047method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16048indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16049
16050As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16051when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16052mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16053the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16054ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16055
16056Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16057multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16058when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016059incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16060are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16062all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16063
16064Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16065 - name
16066 - name(arg1)
16067 - name(arg1,arg2)
16068
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016069
160707.3.1. Converters
16071-----------------
16072
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016073Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16074of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16075is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16076was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016077has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016078unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16079
16080These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16081sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16082the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016083support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016084
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016085A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16086support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16087supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16088(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16089bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016092
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001609351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16094 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16095 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16096 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16097 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16098 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16099
16100 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016101 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16102 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016103 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16104 frontend http-in
16105 bind *:8081
16106 default_backend servers
16107 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16108 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16109
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016110add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016111 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016112 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016113 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16114 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016115 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016116 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16117 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16118 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16119 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016120 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016121 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016122
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016123aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16124 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16125 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16126 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16127 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16128 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16129 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16130
16131 Example:
16132 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16133 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16134
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016135and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016136 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016137 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016138 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16139 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016140 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016141 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16142 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16143 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16144 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016145 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016146 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016147
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016148b64dec
16149 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16150 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016151 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16152 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016153
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016154base64
16155 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016156 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016157 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16158 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016159
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016160bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016161 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016162 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016163 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016164 presence of a flag).
16165
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016166bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16167 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16168 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016169 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016170
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016171concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16172 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16173 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16174 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16175 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16176 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16177 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16178 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16179 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16180 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16181 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016182 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016183 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016184 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16185 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016186
16187 Example:
16188 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16189 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16190 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016191 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016192 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16193
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016194cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016195 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16196 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016197
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016198crc32([<avalanche>])
16199 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16200 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16201 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16202 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16203 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16204 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16205 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16206 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16207 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16208 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016209 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16210
16211crc32c([<avalanche>])
16212 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16213 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16214 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16215 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16216 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16217 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16218 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16219 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016220
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016221cut_crlf
16222 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16223 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16224 updated.
16225
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016226da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016227 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16228 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16229 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16230 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016231 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016232 configuration language.
16233
16234 Example:
16235 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016236 bind *:8881
16237 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016238 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016239
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016240debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16241 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16242 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16243 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16244 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16245 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16246 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16247 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16248 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16249 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16250 printable sample types.
16251
16252 Example:
16253 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016254
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016255digest(<algorithm>)
16256 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16257 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16258
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016259 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016260 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16261
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016262div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016263 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16264 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016265 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016266 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16267 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016268 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016269 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16270 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16271 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16272 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016274 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016275
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016276djb2([<avalanche>])
16277 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16278 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16279 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16280 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16281 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16282 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16283 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016284 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16285 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016286
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016287even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016288 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016289 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16290
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016291field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16292 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16293 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16294 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16295 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16296 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16297 fields.
16298
16299 Example :
16300 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16301 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16302 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16303 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16304 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016305
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016306fix_is_valid
16307 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16308 Information eXchange):
16309
16310 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16311 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016312 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016313 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016314 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016315 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16316 checksum
16317
16318 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16319 the server can be parsed.
16320
16321 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16322 message, false if not.
16323
16324 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16325
16326 Example:
16327 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16328 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16329
16330fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16331 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16332 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16333 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16334 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016335 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016336 added.
16337
16338 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16339 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16340 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16341 fix_is_valid converter.
16342
16343 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16344
16345 Example:
16346 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16347 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16348 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16349 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16350 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16351
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016352hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016353 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016354 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016355 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016356 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016357
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016358hex2i
16359 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016360 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016361
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016362htonl
16363 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16364 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16365 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16366 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16367
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016368hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016369 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16370 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16371 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16372 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16373
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016374 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016375 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16376
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016377http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016378 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16379 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016380 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16381 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16382 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16383 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16384 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16385 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16386 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16387 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016389iif(<true>,<false>)
16390 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16391 string otherwise.
16392
16393 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016394 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016395
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016396in_table(<table>)
16397 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16398 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16399 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016400 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016401 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16402
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016403ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016404 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016405 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016406 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16407 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16408 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16409 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16410 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016411
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016412json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016413 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016414 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016415 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016416 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16417 of errors:
16418 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16419 bytes, ...)
16420 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16421 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16422
16423 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16424 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16425 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16426 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16427 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16428 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016429 - "ascii" : never fails;
16430 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16431 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016432 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016433 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016434 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16435 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16436
16437 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016438 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016439
16440 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016441 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016442 capture request header user-agent len 150
16443 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016444
16445 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16446 GET / HTTP/1.0
16447 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16448
16449 Output log:
16450 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16451
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016452json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16453 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16454 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16455 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16456 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16457
16458 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16459 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16460
16461 Example:
16462 # get a integer value from the request body
16463 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16464 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16465
16466 # get a key with '.' in the name
16467 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16468 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16469
16470 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16471 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16472
16473 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16474 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16475
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016476language(<value>[,<default>])
16477 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16478 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16479 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16480 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16481 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16482 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16483 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16484 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16485 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016486 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016487 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16488 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016489
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016490 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016492 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16493 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016495 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16496 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16497 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16498 use_backend spanish if es
16499 use_backend french if fr
16500 use_backend english if en
16501 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016502
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016503length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016504 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16505 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16506 type. The result is of type integer.
16507
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016508lower
16509 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16510 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16511 type. The result is of type string.
16512
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016513ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16514 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16515 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16516 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16517 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16518 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16519 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16520
16521 Example :
16522
16523 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016524 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016525 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16526
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016527ltrim(<chars>)
16528 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16529 representation of the input sample.
16530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016531map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16532map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16533map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16534 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16535 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16536 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16537 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16538 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16539 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16540 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16541 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016543 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16544 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16545 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016546
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016547 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016548 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016550 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16551 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16552 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16553 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016554 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16555 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016556 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16557 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16558 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16559 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16560 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16561 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16562 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16563 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016564 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16565 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16566 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016567 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16568 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16569 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16570 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16571 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016572
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016573 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16574 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16575 the corresponding match text.
16576
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016577 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16578 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16579 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16580 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16581 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016582
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016583 Example :
16584
16585 # this is a comment and is ignored
16586 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16587 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16588 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16589 | | | `---------- value
16590 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16591 | `---------------------------- key
16592 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16593
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016594mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016595 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16596 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016597 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016598 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016599 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016600 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16601 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16602 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16603 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016604 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016605 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016606
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016607mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016608 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16609 <packettype>.
16610 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16611 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16612 from.
16613 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16614 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16615 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16616
16617 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16618 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16619 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16620 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16621
16622 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16623 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16624 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16625 packets only):
16626 17: Session Expiry Interval
16627 33: Receive Maximum
16628 39: Maximum Packet Size
16629 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16630 25: Request Response Information
16631 23: Request Problem Information
16632 21: Authentication Method
16633 22: Authentication Data
16634 18: Will Delay Interval
16635 1: Payload Format Indicator
16636 2: Message Expiry Interval
16637 3: Content Type
16638 8: Response Topic
16639 9: Correlation Data
16640 Not supported yet:
16641 38: User Property
16642
16643 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16644 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16645 packets only):
16646 17: Session Expiry Interval
16647 33: Receive Maximum
16648 36: Maximum QoS
16649 37: Retain Available
16650 39: Maximum Packet Size
16651 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16652 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16653 31: Reason String
16654 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16655 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16656 42: Shared Subscription Available
16657 19: Server Keep Alive
16658 26: Response Information
16659 28: Server Reference
16660 21: Authentication Method
16661 22: Authentication Data
16662 Not supported yet:
16663 38: User Property
16664
16665 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16666 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16667 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16668 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16669
16670 Example:
16671
16672 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16673 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16674 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16675 if data_in_buffer
16676 # do the same as above
16677 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16678 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16679 if data_in_buffer
16680
16681mqtt_is_valid
16682 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16683
16684 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16685 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16686 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16687 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16688
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016689 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16690
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016691 Example:
16692
16693 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016694 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016695
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016696mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016697 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016698 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16699 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016700 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016701 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016702 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016703 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16704 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16705 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16706 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016707 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016708 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016709
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016710nbsrv
16711 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16712 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16713 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16714 map lookup.
16715
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016716neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016717 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16718 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16719 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16720 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016721
16722not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016723 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016724 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016725 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016726 absence of a flag).
16727
16728odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016729 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016730 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16731
16732or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016733 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016734 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016735 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16736 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016737 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016738 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16739 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16740 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16741 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016742 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016743 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016744
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016745protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16746 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16747 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16748 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16749 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16750 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16751 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16752 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16753 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16754 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16755 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16756 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16757
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016758regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016759 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16760 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16761 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16762 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16763 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16764 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16765 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16766 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16767 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016768 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16769 of characters with other ones.
16770
16771 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16772 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16773 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16774 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16775 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16776 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016777
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016778 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016779
16780 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16781 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16782 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016783 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016784
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016785 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16786 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16787
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016788 # capture groups and backreferences
16789 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016790 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016791 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16792
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016793capture-req(<id>)
16794 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16795 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16796
16797 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016798 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16799 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016800
16801capture-res(<id>)
16802 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16803 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16804
16805 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016806 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16807 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016808
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016809rtrim(<chars>)
16810 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16811 of the input sample.
16812
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016813sdbm([<avalanche>])
16814 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16815 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16816 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16817 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16818 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16819 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16820 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016821 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16822 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016823
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016824secure_memcmp(<var>)
16825 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16826 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16827 match.
16828
16829 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16830 performed in constant time.
16831
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016832 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016833 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16834
16835 Example :
16836
16837 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16838 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16839 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16840 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16841
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016842set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016843 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16844 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16845 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016846 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016847 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16848 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016849 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016850 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16851 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016852 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016853 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016854
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016855sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016856 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016857 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16858
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016859sha2([<bits>])
16860 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16861 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16862
16863 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16864 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16865
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016866 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016867 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16868
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016869srv_queue
16870 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16871 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16872 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16873 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16874 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16875
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016876strcmp(<var>)
16877 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16878 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16879 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16880 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16881 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16882 shorter).
16883
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016884 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16885 strings in constant time.
16886
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016887 Example :
16888
16889 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16890 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16891 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16892
16893
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016894sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016895 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16896 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016897 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016898 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16899 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016900 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016901 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16902 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016903 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016904 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16905 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016906 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016907 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016908
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016909table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16913 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16914 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16915 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16916
16917
16918table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16919 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16920 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16921 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16922 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16923 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16924 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16925
16926table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16927 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16928 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016929 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016930 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16931 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16932
16933table_conn_cur(<table>)
16934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16937 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16938 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16939
16940table_conn_rate(<table>)
16941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16944 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16945 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16946
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016947table_gpt0(<table>)
16948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16951 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16952 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16953
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016954table_gpc0(<table>)
16955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16957 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16958 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16959 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16960
16961table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16962 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16963 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16964 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16965 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16966 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16967 sample fetch keyword.
16968
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016969table_gpc1(<table>)
16970 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16971 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16972 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16973 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16974 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16975
16976table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16980 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16981 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16982 sample fetch keyword.
16983
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016984table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16985 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16986 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016987 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016988 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16989 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16990
16991table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16994 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16995 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16996 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16997 keyword.
16998
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016999table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17003 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17004 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17005
17006table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17007 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17008 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17009 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17010 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17011 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17012 keyword.
17013
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017014table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17015 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17016 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017017 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017018 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17019 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17020
17021table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17022 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17023 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17024 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17025 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17026 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17027 keyword.
17028
17029table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017033 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17034 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17035 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17036 keyword.
17037
17038table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017042 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17043 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17044 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17045 keyword.
17046
17047table_server_id(<table>)
17048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17050 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17051 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17052 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17053 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17054
17055table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017059 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17060 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17061 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17062 keyword.
17063
17064table_sess_rate(<table>)
17065 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17066 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17067 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17068 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17069 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17070 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17071 keyword.
17072
17073table_trackers(<table>)
17074 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17075 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17076 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17077 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17078 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17079 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17080 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17081 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17082 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17083 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17084
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017085ub64dec
17086 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17087 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17088 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17089
17090 Example:
17091 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17092 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17093
17094ub64enc
17095 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17096
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017097upper
17098 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17099 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17100 type. The result is of type string.
17101
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017102url_dec([<in_form>])
17103 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17104 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17105 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17106 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17107 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17108 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017109
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017110url_enc([<enc_type>])
17111 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17112 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17113 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17114 optional argument is here for future changes.
17115
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017116ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017117 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017118 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17119 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17120 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017121 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17122 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17123 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17124 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017125 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017126 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17127 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017128
17129 Example:
17130 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17131 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17132
17133 message Point {
17134 int32 latitude = 1;
17135 int32 longitude = 2;
17136 }
17137
17138 message PPoint {
17139 Point point = 59;
17140 }
17141
17142 message Rectangle {
17143 // One corner of the rectangle.
17144 PPoint lo = 48;
17145 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17146 PPoint hi = 49;
17147 }
17148
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017149 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17150 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17151 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017152
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017153 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17154 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017155 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017156 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17157
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017158 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017159
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017160 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017161
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017162 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17163 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17164 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017165
17166 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17167 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17168 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17169
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017170 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17171 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17172 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017173
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017174
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017175unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017176 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17177 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17178 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17179 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17180 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17181 response),
17182 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17183 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17184 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17185 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17186
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017187utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17188 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17189 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17190 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17191 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17192 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17193 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17194
17195 Example :
17196
17197 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017198 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017199 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17200
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017201word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17202 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17203 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17204 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017205 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017206 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17207 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17208
17209 Example :
17210 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17211 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17212 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17213 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17214 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017215 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017216
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017217wt6([<avalanche>])
17218 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17219 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17220 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17221 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17222 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17223 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17224 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017225 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17226 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017227
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017228xor(<value>)
17229 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017230 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017231 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017232 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017233 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017234 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17235 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017236 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017237 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17238 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017239 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017240 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017241
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017242xxh3([<seed>])
17243 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17244 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17245 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17246 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17247 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17248 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17249 considered as cryptographically secure.
17250
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017251xxh32([<seed>])
17252 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17253 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17254 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17255 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17256 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17257 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17258 as cryptographically secure.
17259
17260xxh64([<seed>])
17261 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17262 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17263 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17264 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17265 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17266 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17267 as cryptographically secure.
17268
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017269
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172707.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017271--------------------------------------------
17272
17273A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17274not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17275"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17276The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17277
17278always_false : boolean
17279 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17280 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17281
17282always_true : boolean
17283 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17284 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17285
17286avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017287 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017288 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17289 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17290 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17291 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17292 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17293 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17294 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17295 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17296 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17297 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17298 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17299 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17300 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017302be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017303 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17304 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17305 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17306 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017307 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17308
17309be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17310 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17311 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17312 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17313 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17314 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017315 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17316 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017317
17318 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17319 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17320 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017322be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17324 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17325 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017326 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17328 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017329
17330 Example :
17331 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17332 backend dynamic
17333 mode http
17334 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17335 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017337bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017338 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17339 of the string.
17340
17341bool(<bool>) : bool
17342 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17343 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17346 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017347 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017348 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17349 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017350
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017351 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017352 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017353 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17354
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017355 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17356 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017357
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017358 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017359 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017361 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017362 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017363 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017364 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017365
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017366 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17367 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017368 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017369 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017370
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017371cpu_calls : integer
17372 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17373 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17374 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17375 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17376 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17377 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17378
17379cpu_ns_avg : integer
17380 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17381 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17382 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17383 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17384 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17385 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17386 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17387 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17388 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17389 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17390 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17391
17392cpu_ns_tot : integer
17393 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17394 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17395 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17396 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17397 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17398 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17399 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17400 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17401 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17402 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17403 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17404 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17405 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17406
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017407date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017408 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017409
17410 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17411 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17412 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017413 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17414
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017415 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17416 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17417 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17418 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17419 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17420
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017421 Example :
17422
17423 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17424 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017425
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017426 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17427 # millisecond granularity
17428 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17429
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017430date_us : integer
17431 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17432 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17433 from the same timeval structure.
17434
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017435distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17436 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17437 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17438 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17439 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017440 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017441 list of supported tokens.
17442
17443distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17444 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17445 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17446 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17447 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017448 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017449 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17450 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17451 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17452 supported tokens.
17453
17454 Example :
17455 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17456 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17457 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17458 # send large files to the big farm
17459 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17460
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017461env(<name>) : string
17462 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17463 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17464 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17465 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17466 certain way.
17467
17468 Examples :
17469 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17470 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17471
17472 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017473 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017475fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17476 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017477 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17478 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017479 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17480 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017481 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17483 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017484
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017485fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17486 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17487 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17488 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17492 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17493 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17494 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17495 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17496 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17497 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17498 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017499
17500 Example :
17501 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17502 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17503 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17504 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17505 frontend mail
17506 bind :25
17507 mode tcp
17508 maxconn 100
17509 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17510 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17511 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17512 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017513
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017514hostname : string
17515 Returns the system hostname.
17516
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017517int(<integer>) : signed integer
17518 Returns a signed integer.
17519
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017520ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17521 Returns an ipv4.
17522
17523ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17524 Returns an ipv6.
17525
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017526lat_ns_avg : integer
17527 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17528 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17529 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17530 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17531 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17532 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17533 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17534 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17535 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017536 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17537 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17538 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17539 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17540 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17541 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017542
17543lat_ns_tot : integer
17544 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17545 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17546 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17547 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17548 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17549 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17550 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17551 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17552 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017553 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17554 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17555 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17556 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17557 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017558 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17559 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17560 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17561 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17562 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17563 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17564
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017565meth(<method>) : method
17566 Returns a method.
17567
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017568nbproc : integer
17569 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17570 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17571 and debugging purposes.
17572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17574 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17575 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17576 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017577 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17578 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17579 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017580
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017581prio_class : integer
17582 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17583 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17584 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17585
17586prio_offset : integer
17587 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17588 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17589 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17590 set-priority-offset".
17591
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017592proc : integer
17593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17594 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17595 debugging purposes.
17596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017597queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017598 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17599 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17600 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017601 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17602 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17603 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17604 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17605 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17606
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017607rand([<range>]) : integer
17608 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17609 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17610 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17611 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17612 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17615 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17616 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17617 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17618 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17619 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017620 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17621 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17622
17623srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17624 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17625 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17626 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17627 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17628 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17629 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17630 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17631
17632 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17633 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017634
17635srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17636 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17637 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17638 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017639 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017640 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17641 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17642 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17643
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017644srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17646 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17647 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17648 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17649 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17650 fetch methods.
17651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017652srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17653 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17654 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017655 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017656 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17657 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017658 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659 overloading servers).
17660
17661 Example :
17662 # Redirect to a separate back
17663 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17664 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17665 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17666
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017667srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017668 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17669 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17670 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17671
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017672srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017673 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17674 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17675 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17676
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017677srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017678 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17679 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17680 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17681
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017682stopping : boolean
17683 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17684 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17685 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17686
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017687str(<string>) : string
17688 Returns a string.
17689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017690table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17691 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17692 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17693
17694table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17695 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17696 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17697 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17698
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017699thread : integer
17700 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17701 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17702 and debugging purposes.
17703
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017704uuid([<version>]) : string
17705 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17706 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17707 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17708
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017709var(<var-name>) : undefined
17710 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017711 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17712 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017713 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017714 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17715 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017716 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017717 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17718 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017719 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017720 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177227.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723----------------------------------
17724
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017725The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017726closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17727methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17728sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17729TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017730the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17731counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017732"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17733used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17734can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17735Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17736table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17737tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17738currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017739
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017740bc_dst : ip
17741 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17742 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17743 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17744 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17745
17746bc_dst_port : integer
17747 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017748 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017749
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017750bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017751 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17752 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17753 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17754
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017755bc_src : ip
17756 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017757 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017758 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17759 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17760
17761bc_src_port : integer
17762 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017763 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017765be_id : integer
17766 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017767 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17768 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017769
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017770be_name : string
17771 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017772 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17773 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017774
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017775be_server_timeout : integer
17776 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17777 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17778 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17779
17780be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17781 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17782 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17783 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17784
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017785cur_server_timeout : integer
17786 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17787 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17788 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17789
17790cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17791 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17792 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17793 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017795dst : ip
17796 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17797 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17798 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17799 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017800 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17801 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17802 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17803 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17804 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17805 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806
17807dst_conn : integer
17808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17809 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17810 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17811 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17812 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17813 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17814 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17815 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017816
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017817dst_is_local : boolean
17818 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17819 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17820 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17821 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017822 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017823 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17824 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17825 it only once per connection.
17826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827dst_port : integer
17828 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17829 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17830 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17831 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17832 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17833 an HTTP header.
17834
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017835fc_fackets : integer
17836 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17837 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17838 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17839 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17840
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017841fc_http_major : integer
17842 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17843 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17844 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17845
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017846fc_lost : integer
17847 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17848 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17849 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17850 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17851
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017852fc_pp_authority : string
17853 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17854 if any.
17855
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017856fc_pp_unique_id : string
17857 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17858 if any.
17859
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017860fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17861 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17862 header.
17863
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017864fc_reordering : integer
17865 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17866 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17867 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17868 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17869
17870fc_retrans : integer
17871 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17872 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17873 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17874 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17875
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017876fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17877 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17878 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17879 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17880 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17881 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17882 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17883
17884fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17885 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17886 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17887 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17888 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17889 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17890 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17891
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017892fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017893 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17894 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17895 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17896 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17897
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017898
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017899fc_unacked : integer
17900 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17901 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17902 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17903 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017904
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017905fe_defbe : string
17906 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17907 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017909fe_id : integer
17910 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017911 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017912 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17913
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017914fe_name : string
17915 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17916 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17917 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17918
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017919fe_client_timeout : integer
17920 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17921 current frontend.
17922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017923sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017924sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17925sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17926sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017927 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17928 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17929 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17930
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017931sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017932sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17933sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17934sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017935 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17936 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17937 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17938
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017939sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017940sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17941sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17942sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017943 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17944 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017945 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17946 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17947 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017948
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017949 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017950 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17951 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017952 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17953 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17954 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017955 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17956 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17957
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017958sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17959sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17960sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17961sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17962 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17963 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17964 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17965 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17966 when a first ACL was verified.
17967
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017968sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017969sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17970sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17971sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017972 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017973 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017975sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017976sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17977sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17978sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017979 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17980 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17981 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17982
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017983sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017984sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17985sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17986sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017987 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17988 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17989 See also src_conn_rate.
17990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017991sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017992sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17993sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17994sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017995 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017996 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017997
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017998sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17999sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18000sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18001sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18002 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18003 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18004
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018005sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18006sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18007sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18008sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18009 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18010 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18011
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018012sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018013sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18014sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18015sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018016 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18017 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18018 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018019 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18020 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18021 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018022
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018023sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18024sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18025sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18026sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18027 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18028 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18029 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18030 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18031 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18032 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18033
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018034sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018035sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18036sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18037sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018038 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018039 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18040 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18041
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018042sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018043sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18044sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18045sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018046 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18047 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18048 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18049 src_http_err_rate.
18050
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018051sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18052sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18053sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18054sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18055 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18056 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18057 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18058
18059sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18060sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18061sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18062sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18063 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18064 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18065 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18066 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18067
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018068sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018069sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18070sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18071sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018072 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018073 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18074 src_http_req_cnt.
18075
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018076sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018077sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18078sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18079sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018080 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18081 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18082 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18083 src_http_req_rate.
18084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018085sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018086sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18087sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18088sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018089 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018090 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18091 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18092 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18093 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018094
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018095 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018096 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18097 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018098 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18099
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018100sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18101sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18102sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18103sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18104 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18105 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18106 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18107 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18108 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018110sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018111sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18112sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18113sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018114 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18115 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18116 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018117
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018118sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018119sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18120sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18121sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018122 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18123 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18124 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018125
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018126sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018127sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18128sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18129sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018130 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018131 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18132 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18133 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018134 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018135 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18136
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018137sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018138sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18139sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18140sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018141 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18142 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18143 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18144 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18145 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018146 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018147
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018148sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018149sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18150sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18151sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018152 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18153 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18154 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18155
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018156sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018157sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18158sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18159sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018160 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18161 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018162 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018163 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18164 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018165 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18166 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18167 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018169so_id : integer
18170 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18171 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18172 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018173
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018174so_name : string
18175 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18176 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18177 strings instead of integers.
18178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018180 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18182 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18183 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018184 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18185 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18186 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018187 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18188 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18189 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18190 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18191 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18192 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18193 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018194
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018195 Example:
18196 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18197 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018199src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18200 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18201 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18202 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018203 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018205src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18206 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18207 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018208 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018209 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018211src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18212 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18213 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18214 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18215 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18216 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18217 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018218
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018219 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018220 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18221 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18222 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18223 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018224 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018225 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18226 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18227
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018228src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18229 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18230 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18231 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18232 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18233 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18234 was verified.
18235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018237 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018238 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018239 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018240 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018242src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018243 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18245 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018246 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18249 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18250 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18251 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018252 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018254src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018255 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018256 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018257 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018258 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018259
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018260src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18261 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18262 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18263 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18264 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18265
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018266src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18267 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18268 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18269 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18270 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018273 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018274 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018275 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18276 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018277 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18278 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18279 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018280
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018281src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18282 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18283 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18284 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18285 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18286 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18287 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18288 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018290src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018291 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018293 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018294 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018295 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018297src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18298 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18299 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18300 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18301 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018302 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018303
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018304src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18305 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18306 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018307 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018308 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18309 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18310
18311src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18312 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18313 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18314 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18315 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18316 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18317 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018319src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018320 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18322 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018323 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18326 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18327 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18328 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018329 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018330 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018332src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18333 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18334 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18335 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018336 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18338 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018339
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018340 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018341 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018342 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018343 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018344
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018345src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18346 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18347 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18348 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18349 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18350 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18351 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18352
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018353src_is_local : boolean
18354 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18355 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18356 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18357 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018358 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018359 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18360 once per connection.
18361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018362src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018363 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18364 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18365 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18366 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18367 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018369src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018370 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18371 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18372 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18373 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18374 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376src_port : integer
18377 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18378 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18379 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18380 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018383 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018384 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18385 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18386 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018387 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18390 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18391 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18392 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18393 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018394 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18397 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18398 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18399 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18400 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18401 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18402 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18403 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18404 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018405
18406 Example :
18407 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18408 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18409 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18410 listen ssh
18411 bind :22
18412 mode tcp
18413 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018414 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018416 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418srv_id : integer
18419 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18420 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018421 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018422
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018423srv_name : string
18424 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18425 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018426 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018427
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184287.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018429----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018430
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018431The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18433when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18434usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018435future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018436
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001843751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18438 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18439 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18440 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18441 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18442 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18443
18444 Example :
18445 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18446 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18447 # the request.
18448 frontend http-in
18449 bind *:8081
18450 default_backend servers
18451 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18452 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18453
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018454ssl_bc : boolean
18455 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18456 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018457 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18458 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018459
18460ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18461 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018462 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18463 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018464
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018465ssl_bc_alpn : string
18466 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18467 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018468 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018469 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18470 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18471 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18472 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18473 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018474 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18475 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018476
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018477ssl_bc_cipher : string
18478 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018479 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18480 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018481
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018482ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18483 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18484 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18485 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018486 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018487
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018488ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18489 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18490 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018491 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18492 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018493
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018494ssl_bc_npn : string
18495 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18496 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018497 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018498 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18499 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18500 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18501 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018502 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18503 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018504
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018505ssl_bc_protocol : string
18506 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018507 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18508 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018509
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018510ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018511 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018512 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018513 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18514 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018515
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018516ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18517 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18518 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18519 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018520 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018521
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018522ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18523 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18524 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018525 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18526 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018527
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018528ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18529 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18530 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18531 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018532 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018533
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018534ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18535 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018536 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18537 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018539ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18540 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18541 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18542 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18543 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18544 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018546ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18547 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18548 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18549 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18550 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018551
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018552ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018553 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18554 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18555 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018556 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018557 does not support resumed sessions.
18558
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018559ssl_c_der : binary
18560 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18561 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18562 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564ssl_c_err : integer
18565 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18566 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18567 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18568 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18569 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018570
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018571ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018572 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18573 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18574 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18575 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18576 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18577 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18578 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18579 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018580 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18581 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18582 LDAP v3.
18583 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18584 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018586ssl_c_key_alg : string
18587 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18588 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18589 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018591ssl_c_notafter : string
18592 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18593 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18594 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018596ssl_c_notbefore : string
18597 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18598 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18599 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018600
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018601ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018602 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18603 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18604 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18605 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18606 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18607 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18608 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18609 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018610 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18611 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18612 LDAP v3.
18613 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18614 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018616ssl_c_serial : binary
18617 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18618 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18619 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018621ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18622 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18623 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18624 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018625 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18626 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18627
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018628 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018629 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018631ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18632 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18633 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18634 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018636ssl_c_used : boolean
18637 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18638 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640ssl_c_verify : integer
18641 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18642 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18643 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18644 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018646ssl_c_version : integer
18647 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18648 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018649
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018650ssl_f_der : binary
18651 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18652 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18653 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18654
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018655ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018656 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18657 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18658 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18659 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018660 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018661 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18662 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18663 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018664 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18665 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18666 LDAP v3.
18667 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18668 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018670ssl_f_key_alg : string
18671 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18672 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18673 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675ssl_f_notafter : string
18676 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18677 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18678 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018680ssl_f_notbefore : string
18681 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18682 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18683 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018684
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018685ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018686 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18687 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18688 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18689 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18690 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18691 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18692 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18693 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018694 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18695 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18696 LDAP v3.
18697 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18698 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700ssl_f_serial : binary
18701 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18702 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18703 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018704
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018705ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18706 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18707 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18708 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018710ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18711 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18712 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18713 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018715ssl_f_version : integer
18716 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18717 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18718
18719ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018720 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18721 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18722 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724 Example :
18725 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18726 listen http-https
18727 bind :80
18728 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18729 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18730
18731ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18732 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18733 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18734
18735ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018736 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018737 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018738 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018739 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18740 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18741 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18742 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18743 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18744 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018746ssl_fc_cipher : string
18747 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18748 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018749
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018750ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18751 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18752 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018753 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018754
18755ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18756 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18757 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018758 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018759
18760ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18761 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18762 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18763 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018764 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018765 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018766
18767ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18768 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18769 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018770 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018771
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018772ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18773 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18774 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18775 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18776
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018777ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18778 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18779 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18780 transport layer.
18781 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18782 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18783 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18784 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18785
18786ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18787 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18788 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18789 transport layer.
18790 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18791 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18792 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18793 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18794
18795ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18796 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18797 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18798 transport layer.
18799 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18800 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18801 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18802 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18803
18804ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18805 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18806 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18807 transport layer.
18808 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18809 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18810 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18811 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18812
18813ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18814 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18815 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18816 transport layer.
18817 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18818 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18819 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18820 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018823 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18824 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018825 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18826 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18827 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18828 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018829
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018830ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18831 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18832 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18833 wait until the handshake happened.
18834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18836 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018837 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18838 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018839 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018840 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018841
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018842ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018843 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018844 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18845 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018847ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018848 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018849 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18851 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18852 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18853 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18854 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18855 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018857ssl_fc_protocol : string
18858 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18859 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018860
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018861ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018862 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018863 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018864 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018865
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018866ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18867 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18868 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18869 transport layer.
18870 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18871 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18872 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18873 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18874
18875ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18876 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18877 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18878 transport layer.
18879 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18880 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18881 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18882 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18883
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018884ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18885 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18886 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18887 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18890 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18891 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18892 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18893 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018894
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018895ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18896 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18897 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18898 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18899 BoringSSL.
18900
18901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018902ssl_fc_sni : string
18903 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18904 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018905 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018906 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18907 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18908
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018909 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018910 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018911 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018912 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018913 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018914
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018915 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18916 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18917 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18918 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18919 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18920 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18921 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18922 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18923 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018925 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018926 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18927 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018929ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18930 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18931 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018932
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018933ssl_s_der : binary
18934 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18935 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18936 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18937
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018938ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18939 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18940 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18941 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018942 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018943 does not support resumed sessions.
18944
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018945ssl_s_key_alg : string
18946 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18947 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18948 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18949
18950ssl_s_notafter : string
18951 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18952 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18953 transport layer.
18954
18955ssl_s_notbefore : string
18956 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18957 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18958 transport layer.
18959
18960ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18961 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18962 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18963 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18964 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18965 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18966 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018967 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18968 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018969 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18970 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18971 LDAP v3.
18972 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18973 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18974
18975ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18976 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18977 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18978 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18979 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18980 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18981 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018982 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18983 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018984 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18985 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18986 LDAP v3.
18987 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18988 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18989
18990ssl_s_serial : binary
18991 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18992 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18993 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18994
18995ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18996 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18997 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18998 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18999
19000ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19001 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19002 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19003 layer.
19004
19005ssl_s_version : integer
19006 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19007 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019008
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190097.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019010------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19013sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19014only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19015For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19016be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19017can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19018sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19019for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19020content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019021
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019022Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19023 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019024 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019025 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19026 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19027 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19028 sample expression). So be careful.
19029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019030payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019031 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19033 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019035payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19036 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019037 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019038 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019040req.len : integer
19041req_len : integer (deprecated)
19042 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19043 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19044 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19045 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19046 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019047 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019048 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19049 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019051req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19052 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019053 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19054 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19055 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19056 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019057
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019058 ACL derivatives :
19059 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19062 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19063 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19064 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19065 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019066
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019067 ACL derivatives :
19068 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019070 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072req.proto_http : boolean
19073req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19074 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19075 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19076 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19077 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19078 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19079 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19080 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019082 Example:
19083 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19084 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19085 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019086 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019088req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19089rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19090 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19091 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19092 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19093 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19094 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19095 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19096 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019098 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19099 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19100 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19101 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19102 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19103 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019105 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019106 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019108 Example :
19109 listen tse-farm
19110 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19111 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19112 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19113 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19114 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19115 persist rdp-cookie
19116 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19117 # This is only useful makes sense if
19118 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19119 stick-table type string size 204800
19120 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19121 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19122 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019125 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019127req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19128rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19129 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19130 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19131 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19132 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019134 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019135 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019136
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019137req.ssl_alpn : string
19138 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19139 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19140 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19141 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19142 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19143 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019144 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019145
19146 Examples :
19147 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19148 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019149 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019150 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019151 default_backend bk_default
19152
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019153req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19154 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19155 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019156 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19157 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19158 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19159 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19160 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019162req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19163req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19164 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19165 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19166 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19167 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19168 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19169 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19170 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019172req.ssl_sni : string
19173req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19174 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19175 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19176 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19177 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19178 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019179 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19180 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19181 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19182 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19183 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19184 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19185 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19186 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19187 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019189 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019190 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019192 Examples :
19193 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19194 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019195 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019196 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019198
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019199req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19200 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19201 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19202 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19203 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19204 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19205 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19206 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19207 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19208 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019210req.ssl_ver : integer
19211req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19212 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19213 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19214 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19215 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19216 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19217 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19218 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019219 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019220 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019223 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019224
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019225res.len : integer
19226 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19227 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19228 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19229 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19230 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019231 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019232 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019233 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019235res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19236 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019237 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019238 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019239 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019240 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019242res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19243 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19244 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19245 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019246 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19247 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019249 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019250
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019251res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19252rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19253 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19254 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19255 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19256 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19257 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19258 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19259 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261wait_end : boolean
19262 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19263 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019264 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019265 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19266 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019267 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19269 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019271 Examples :
19272 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19273 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19274 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019276 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19277 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19278 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19279 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19280 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19281 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19282 tcp-request content reject
19283
19284
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192857.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019286--------------------------------------
19287
19288It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19289This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19290data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19291its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19292HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19293content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19294to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19295more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19296response are indexed.
19297
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019298Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19299 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19300 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19301 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19302 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19303 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19304 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019306base : string
19307 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19308 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19309 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19310 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19311 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19312 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19313 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19314 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19315
19316 ACL derivatives :
19317 base : exact string match
19318 base_beg : prefix match
19319 base_dir : subdir match
19320 base_dom : domain match
19321 base_end : suffix match
19322 base_len : length match
19323 base_reg : regex match
19324 base_sub : substring match
19325
19326base32 : integer
19327 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19328 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19329 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019330 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19331 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19332 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019333
19334base32+src : binary
19335 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19336 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19337 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19338 per-URL counters.
19339
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019340baseq : string
19341 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19342 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19343 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19344 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19345
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019346capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19347 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19348 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19349 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19350
19351capture.req.method : string
19352 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19353 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19354 because it's allocated.
19355
19356capture.req.uri : string
19357 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19358 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19359 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19360 allocated.
19361
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019362capture.req.ver : string
19363 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19364 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19365 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19366
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019367capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19368 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19369 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19370 The first entry is an index of 0.
19371 See also: "capture response header"
19372
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019373capture.res.ver : string
19374 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19375 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19376 persistent flag.
19377
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019378req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019379 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19380 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19381 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019382
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019383req.body_param([<name>) : string
19384 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19385 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19386 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19387 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19388 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19389 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19390 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19391 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19392 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19393 given.
19394
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019395req.body_len : integer
19396 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19397 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019398 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19399 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019400
19401req.body_size : integer
19402 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019403 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19404 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406req.cook([<name>]) : string
19407cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19408 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19409 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19410 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19411 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19412 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19413 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19414 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19415 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19416
19417 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019418 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19419 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19420 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19421 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19422 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19423 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19424 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19425 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019427req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19428cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19429 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19430 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019432req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19433cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19434 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19435 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19436 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19437 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019439cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19440 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19441 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19442 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19443 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019444 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019445 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19446 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19447 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19448 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019450hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19451 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19452 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19453 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19454 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019455 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019457req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019458 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19459 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19460 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19461 with headers such as User-Agent.
19462
19463 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19464 found.
19465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019466 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19467 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19468 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019469 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019471req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19472 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19473 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019474 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19475 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019477req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019478 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19479 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19480 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19481 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19482 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19483 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19484 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19485
19486 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19487 found.
19488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19490 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19491 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019492 with -1 being the last one.
19493
19494 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19495 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019497 ACL derivatives :
19498 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19499 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19500 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19501 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19502 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19503 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19504 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19505 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19506
19507req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19508hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19509 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19510 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019511 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19512 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19513 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19514
19515 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19516 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19517 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19518
19519 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019520
19521req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19522hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19523 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19524 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19525 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019526 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19527 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19528 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19529 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19530 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019531
19532 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19533
19534 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019535
19536req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19537hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19538 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19539 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19540 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019541
19542 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19543
19544 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019545
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019546req.hdrs : string
19547 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19548 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19549 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19550 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19551
19552req.hdrs_bin : binary
19553 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19554 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19555 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19556 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19557 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19558 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19559
19560 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019561
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019562 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19563 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019565http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19566 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19567 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19568 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19569 basic auth is supported.
19570
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019571http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19572 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19573 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19574 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19575 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19577 basic auth is supported.
19578
19579 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019580 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19581 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19582 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19583 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019585http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019586 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19587 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19588 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019589
19590http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019591 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19592 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19593 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019594
19595http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019596 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19597 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19598 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019600http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019601 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19602 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019603 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19604 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019606method : integer + string
19607 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19608 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19609 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19610 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19611 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19612 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19613 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019615 ACL derivatives :
19616 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618 Example :
19619 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19620 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19621 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019623path : string
19624 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19625 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19626 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19627 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19628 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019629 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019632 ACL derivatives :
19633 path : exact string match
19634 path_beg : prefix match
19635 path_dir : subdir match
19636 path_dom : domain match
19637 path_end : suffix match
19638 path_len : length match
19639 path_reg : regex match
19640 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019641
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019642pathq : string
19643 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19644 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19645 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19646 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19647 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19648 result in both cases.
19649
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019650query : string
19651 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19652 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19653 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19654 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019655 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019656 which stops before the question mark.
19657
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019658req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19659 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19660 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19661 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19662 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664req.ver : string
19665req_ver : string (deprecated)
19666 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19667 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19668 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019670 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019671 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019672
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019673res.body : binary
19674 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19675 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019676 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19677
19678 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019679
19680res.body_len : integer
19681 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19682 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019683 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19684
19685 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019686
19687res.body_size : integer
19688 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19689 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19690 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19691 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019692 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19693
19694 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019695
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019696res.cache_hit : boolean
19697 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19698 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19699
19700res.cache_name : string
19701 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19702 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19703 empty string.
19704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019705res.comp : boolean
19706 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19707 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19708 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710res.comp_algo : string
19711 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19712 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19713 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019715res.cook([<name>]) : string
19716scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19717 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19718 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019719 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19720
19721 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019723 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019724 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019726res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19727scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19728 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19729 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019730 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19731
19732 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019734res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19735scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19736 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19737 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019738 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19739
19740 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019742res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019743 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19744 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19745
19746 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19747 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19748
19749 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19750
19751 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019753res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019754 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19755 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19756
19757 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19758 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19759
19760 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019762res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19763shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019764 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19765 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19766
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019767 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019768 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19769
19770 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019772 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019773 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19774 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19775 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19776 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19777 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19778 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19779 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19780 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019781
19782res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19783shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019784 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19785 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19786
19787 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019788 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019789
19790 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019792res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19793shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019794 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19795 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19796
19797 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19798
19799 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019800
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019801res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19802 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19803 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19804 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019805 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19806
19807 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019809res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19810shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019811 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19812 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19813
19814 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19815
19816 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019817
19818res.hdrs : string
19819 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19820 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19821 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019822 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19823
19824 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019825
19826res.hdrs_bin : binary
19827 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19828 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19829 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19830 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19831 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19832 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19833 (length of 0 for both).
19834
19835 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19836
19837 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19838 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019840res.ver : string
19841resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19842 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019843 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19844
19845 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019847 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019848 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019850set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19851 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19852 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019853 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019856 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19857 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019859status : integer
19860 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19861 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019862 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19863
19864 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019865
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019866unique-id : string
19867 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19868 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19869 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19870 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19871 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19872 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019874url : string
19875 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19876 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19877 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19878 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19879 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19880 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19881 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019883 ACL derivatives :
19884 url : exact string match
19885 url_beg : prefix match
19886 url_dir : subdir match
19887 url_dom : domain match
19888 url_end : suffix match
19889 url_len : length match
19890 url_reg : regex match
19891 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893url_ip : ip
19894 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19895 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19896 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19897 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19898 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19899 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19900 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019902url_port : integer
19903 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19904 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19905 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19906 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019907
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019908urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19909url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019910 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19911 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019912 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19913 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19914 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19915 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19917 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019918 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19919 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019921 ACL derivatives :
19922 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19923 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19924 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19925 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19926 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19927 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19928 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19929 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019930
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932 Example :
19933 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19934 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19935 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19936 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019937
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019938urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019939 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19940 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19941 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019942
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019943url32 : integer
19944 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19945 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19946 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19947 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19948 is an unsigned integer.
19949
19950url32+src : binary
19951 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19952 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19953 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19954
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019955
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200199567.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019957---------------------------------------
19958
19959This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19960used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19961purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19962There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19963or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19964any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19965for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19966
19967internal.htx.data : integer
19968 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19969 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19970
19971internal.htx.free : integer
19972 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19973 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19974
19975internal.htx.free_data : integer
19976 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19977 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19978
19979internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019980 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19981 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19982 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019983
19984internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19985 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19986 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19987
19988internal.htx.size : integer
19989 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19990 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19991
19992internal.htx.used : integer
19993 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19994 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19995 direction.
19996
19997internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19998 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19999 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20000 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20001 of the special value :
20002 * head : The oldest inserted block
20003 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020004 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020005
20006internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20007 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20008 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20009 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20010 integer or one of the special value :
20011 * head : The oldest inserted block
20012 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020013 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020014
20015internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20016 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20017 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20018 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20019 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20020
20021 * head : The oldest inserted block
20022 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020023 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020024
20025internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20026 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20027 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20028 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20029 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20030
20031 * head : The oldest inserted block
20032 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020033 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020034
20035internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20036 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20037 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20038 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20039 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20040
20041 * head : The oldest inserted block
20042 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020043 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020044
20045internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20046 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20047 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20048 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20049 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20050
20051 * head : The oldest inserted block
20052 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020053 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020054
20055internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20056 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20057 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20058 it returns false.
20059
20060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200200617.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020062---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020064Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20065every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020066order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020068ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020069---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20070FALSE always_false never match
20071HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20072HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20073HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020074HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020075HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20076HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20077HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20078HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20079LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20080METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20081METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20082METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20083METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20084METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20085METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20086METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20087METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20088RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20089REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20090TRUE always_true always match
20091WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20092---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020093
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200958. Logging
20096----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020097
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020098One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20099provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20100very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20101provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20102state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020103to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020104headers.
20105
20106In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20107about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20108send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20109
20110 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20111 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20112 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20113 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20114 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020115 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020116 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020117
20118The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20119allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20120as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20121while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20122real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20123delay.
20124
20125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201268.1. Log levels
20127---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020128
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020129TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020130source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020131HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20132in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20133track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20134syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20135about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020136
20137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201388.2. Log formats
20139----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020140
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020141HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020142and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20143slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20144options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020145
20146 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20147 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20148 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20149 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20150 extents.
20151
20152 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20153 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20154 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20155 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20156 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20157
20158 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20159 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20160 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20161 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20162 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20163
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020164 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20165 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20166 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20167 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20168
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020169 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20170
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020171Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20172specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20173field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20174servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20175always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20176identifier.
20177
20178Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20179 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20180 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20181 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20182 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20183
20184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201858.2.1. Default log format
20186-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020187
20188This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20189as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20190format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20191
20192 Example :
20193 listen www
20194 mode http
20195 log global
20196 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20197
20198 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20199 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20200 (www/HTTP)
20201
20202 Field Format Extract from the example above
20203 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20204 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20205 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20206 4 'to' to
20207 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20208 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20209
20210Detailed fields description :
20211 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20212 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20213 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20214 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20215 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20216 and processed the connection.
20217 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20218
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020219In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20220"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20221connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20224will eventually disappear.
20225
20226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202278.2.2. TCP log format
20228---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020229
20230The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20231is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20232information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20233counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20234emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20235environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20236the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20237sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020238specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20239not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20240fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20241marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020242
20243 Example :
20244 frontend fnt
20245 mode tcp
20246 option tcplog
20247 log global
20248 default_backend bck
20249
20250 backend bck
20251 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20252
20253 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20254 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20255 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20256
20257 Field Format Extract from the example above
20258 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20259 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20260 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20261 4 frontend_name fnt
20262 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20263 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20264 7 bytes_read* 212
20265 8 termination_state --
20266 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20267 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20268
20269Detailed fields description :
20270 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020271 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020272 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20273 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020274 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020275 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020276 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020277
20278 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020279 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20280 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20281 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020282
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020283 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020284 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20285 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020286 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20287 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20288 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20289 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020290
20291 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20292 and processed the connection.
20293
20294 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20295 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20296 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20297 applications.
20298
20299 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20300 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20301 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20302 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20303 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20304
20305 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20306 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20307 See "Timers" below for more details.
20308
20309 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20310 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20311 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20312 "Timers" below for more details.
20313
20314 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020315 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020316 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20317 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20318 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20319 details.
20320
20321 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20322 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20323 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20324 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20325 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20326
20327 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20328 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20329 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20330 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20331 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20332 for more details.
20333
20334 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020335 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020336 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20337 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20338 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020339 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020340
20341 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20342 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20343 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20344 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20345 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20346 caused by a denial of service attack.
20347
20348 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20349 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20350 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20351 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20352 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20353 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20354 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20355 denial of service attack.
20356
20357 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20358 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20359 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20360 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20361 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20362 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20363 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20364 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20365 be processed than on other servers.
20366
20367 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20368 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20369 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20370 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020371 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020372 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20373 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20374 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20375 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20376 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20377 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20378 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20379 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20380
20381 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20382 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20383 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20384 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20385 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20386 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020387 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020388 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20389
20390 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20391 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20392 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20393 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20394 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20395 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020396 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020397 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20398 occurs.
20399
20400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204018.2.3. HTTP log format
20402----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020403
20404The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20405is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20406the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20407are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20408emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20409generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20410"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20411which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020412frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20413is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020414
20415Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20416slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20417with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20418
20419 Example :
20420 frontend http-in
20421 mode http
20422 option httplog
20423 log global
20424 default_backend bck
20425
20426 backend static
20427 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20428
20429 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20430 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20431 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020432 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020433
20434 Field Format Extract from the example above
20435 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20436 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020437 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020438 4 frontend_name http-in
20439 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020440 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020441 7 status_code 200
20442 8 bytes_read* 2750
20443 9 captured_request_cookie -
20444 10 captured_response_cookie -
20445 11 termination_state ----
20446 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20447 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20448 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20449 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20450 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020452Detailed fields description :
20453 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020454 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020455 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20456 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020457 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020458 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020459 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020460
20461 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020462 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20463 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20464 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020466 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020467 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020468
20469 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20470 and processed the connection.
20471
20472 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20473 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20474 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20475
20476 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20477 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20478 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20479 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20480 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20481 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20482
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020483 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20484 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20485 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020486 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020487 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20488 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020489 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020490 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020491
20492 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20493 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020494 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020495
20496 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20497 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020498 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20499 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020500
20501 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20502 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20503 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20504 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20505 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020506 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20507 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020508
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020509 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020510 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20511 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20512 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20513 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20514 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20515 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020516 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020517
20518 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020519 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20520 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020521
20522 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20523 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020524 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020525 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20526 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20527 overflowing.
20528
20529 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20530 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20531 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20532 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20533 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20534 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20535 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20536 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20537
20538 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20539 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20540 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20541 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20542 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20543 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20544 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20545 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20546
20547 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20548 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20549 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20550 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20551 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20552 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20553 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20554
20555 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020556 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020557 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20558 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20559 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020560 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020561 system.
20562
20563 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20564 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20565 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20566 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20567 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20568 caused by a denial of service attack.
20569
20570 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20571 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20572 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20573 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20574 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20575 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20576 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20577 denial of service attack.
20578
20579 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20580 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20581 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20582 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20583 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20584 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20585 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20586 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20587 processed than on other servers.
20588
20589 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20590 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20591 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20592 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020593 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020594 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20595 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20596 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20597 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20598 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20599 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20600 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20601 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20602
20603 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20604 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20605 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20606 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20607 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20608 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020609 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020610 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20611
20612 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20613 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20614 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20615 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20616 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20617 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020618 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020619 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20620 occurs.
20621
20622 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20623 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20624 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20625 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20626 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20627 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20628 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20629 cookies" below for more details.
20630
20631 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20632 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20633 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20634 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20635 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20636 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20637 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20638 and cookies" below for more details.
20639
20640 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20641 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20642 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20643 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20644 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20645 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20646 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20647 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20648
20649
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200206508.2.4. Custom log format
20651------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020652
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020653The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020654mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020655
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020656HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020657Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20658separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20659prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20660
20661Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20662variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020663("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020664
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020665If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020666as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020667less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20668the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20669
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020670Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20671"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20672delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20673preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020674
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020675Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20676'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20677https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20678such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20679
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020680Flags are :
20681 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020682 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020683 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20684 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020685
20686 Example:
20687
20688 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20689 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20690
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020691 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20692
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020693At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020695 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20696 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020697
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020698the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020700 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20701 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20702 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020703
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020704and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20705
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020706 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20707 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020708
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020709Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20710
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020711 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020712 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020713 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20714 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20715 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020716 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20717 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20718 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020719 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020720 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020721 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020722 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020723 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020724 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20725 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020726 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020727 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020728 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020729 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020730 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020731 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020732 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020733 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20734 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20735 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20736 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20737 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020738 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020739 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020740 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020741 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020742 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020743 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20744 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020745 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20746 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20747 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020748 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020749 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20750 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020751 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020752 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20753 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20754 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020755 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020756 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020757 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20758 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20759 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20760 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020761 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020762 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020763 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020764 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020765 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020766 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020767 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20768 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20769 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020770 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020771 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20772 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020773 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020774 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20775 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020776 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020777 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020778 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020779 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020780
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020781 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020782
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020783
207848.2.5. Error log format
20785-----------------------
20786
20787When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020788protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020789By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20790"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020791will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020792logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20793
20794The format looks like this :
20795
20796 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20797 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20798 Connection error during SSL handshake
20799
20800 Field Format Extract from the example above
20801 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20802 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20803 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20804 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20805 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20806
20807These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20808failures.
20809
20810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208118.3. Advanced logging options
20812-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020813
20814Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20815just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20816options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20817for more information about their usage.
20818
20819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208208.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20821------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020822
20823It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020824HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020825commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20826monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20827ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20828
20829 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20830 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20831 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20832 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20833
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020834 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20835 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020836
20837 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20838 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20839 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20840
20841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208428.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20843----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020844
20845The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20846what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20847or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020848"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020849just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20850log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20851after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20852is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20853with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20854with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20855
20856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208578.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20858------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020859
20860Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20861for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20862"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20863retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20864raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20865a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20866file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20867you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20868"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20869
20870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208718.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20872--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020873
20874Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20875multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20876them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20877"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20878logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20879error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20880and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20881too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20882useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20883alternative.
20884
20885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208868.4. Timing events
20887------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020888
20889Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20890reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20891the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20892frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020893mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20894addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20895
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020896Timings events in HTTP mode:
20897
20898 first request 2nd request
20899 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20900 t tr t tr ...
20901 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20902 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20903 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20904 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020905 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020906 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20907
20908Timings events in TCP mode:
20909
20910 TCP session
20911 |<----------------->|
20912 t t
20913 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20914 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20915 |<------ Tt ------->|
20916
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020917 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020918 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020919 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20920 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20921 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020922 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020923 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20924 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20925 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20926 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020927
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020928 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20929 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20930 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020931 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20932 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20933 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20934 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20935 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20936 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020937
20938 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20939 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20940 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20941 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20942 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20943 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20944 request typed by hand during a test.
20945
20946 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20947 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020948 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020949 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20950 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20951 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20952 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020953
20954 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20955 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20956 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20957 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20958 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20959
20960 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20961 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20962 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20963 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20964 connection never established.
20965
20966 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20967 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20968 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20969 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20970 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20971 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20972 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20973 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20974 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20975 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20976 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20977
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020978 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20979 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20980 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20981 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20982 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20983 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20984
20985 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20986
20987 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20988 "Ta" can never be negative.
20989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020990 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20991 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020992 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20993 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020994 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020995
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020996 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020997
20998 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020999 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21000 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021001
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021002 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21003 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21004 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21005 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21006 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21007 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21008 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21009 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21010
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021011These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21012protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21013that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021014due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21015"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21016that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021017
21018Most common cases :
21019
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021020 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21021 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21022 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21023 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21024 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021025 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021026 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21027 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21028 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21029 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21030 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021031 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021032
21033 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21034 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21035 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21036 of ms on remote networks.
21037
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021038 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21039 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21040 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021042 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21043 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021044 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021045 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21046 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21047 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21048 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21049 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21050 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021051
21052Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21053
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021054 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021056 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021057
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021058 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021059 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21060 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21061
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021062 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021063 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21064 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21065 flags.
21066
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021067 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21068 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021069 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21070 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21071 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21072 the client connection was maintained open.
21073
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021074 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021075 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021076 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021077 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21078
21079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210808.5. Session state at disconnection
21081-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021082
21083TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21084"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210852-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21086each of which has a special meaning :
21087
21088 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21089 session to terminate :
21090
21091 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21092
21093 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21094 server explicitly refused it.
21095
21096 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21097 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21098 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21099 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021100 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021101
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021102 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021103 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021104
21105 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21106 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21107 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21108 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21109 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21110
21111 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21112 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21113 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21114 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21115 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21116
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021117 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021118 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21119
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021120 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021121 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21122 backup connections when going up.
21123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021124 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021125
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021126 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21127 send or receive data.
21128
21129 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21130 send or receive data.
21131
21132 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21133 with nothing left in the buffers.
21134
21135 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21136
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021137 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021138 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21139
21140 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21141 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21142 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21143 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21144 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21145
21146 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21147 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21148
21149 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21150 server (HTTP only).
21151
21152 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21153
21154 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21155 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21156 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21157
21158 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21159 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21160 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21161
21162 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21163
21164 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21165 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21166
21167 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21168 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21169 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21170
21171 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21172 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021173 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21174 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021175
21176 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21177 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21178 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21179 another server.
21180
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021181 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021182 server.
21183
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021184 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21185 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21186 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21187 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21188
21189 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21190 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21191 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21192 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21193
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021194 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21195 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21196 "use-server" rule).
21197
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021198 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21199
21200 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21201 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21202
21203 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21204
21205 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21206 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21207 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21208
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021209 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21210 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021211 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021212 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21213 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21214
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021215 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21216
21217 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21218 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21219
21220 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21221
21222 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21223
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021224The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21225was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021226helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21227starvation, attacks, etc...
21228
21229The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21230alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21231easier finding and understanding.
21232
21233 Flags Reason
21234
21235 -- Normal termination.
21236
21237 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021238 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21239 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021240 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21241
21242 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21243 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021244 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21245 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021246 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21247 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021248
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021249 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21250 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021251 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021252
21253 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21254 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21255 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21256
21257 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21258 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21259 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21260 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21261 the server takes too long to respond.
21262
21263 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21264 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21265 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21266 long a time to respond.
21267
21268 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21269 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21270 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021271 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021272 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21273 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021274
21275 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21276 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21277 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21278 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21279 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021280 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021281 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21282 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21283 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21284 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21285 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21286 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21287 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21288 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021289 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021290 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21291 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21292 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021293
21294 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21295 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021296 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21297 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21298 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21299 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021300
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021301 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021302 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21303
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021304 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021305 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21306 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021307 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021308 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21309 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21310
21311 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21312 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21313 503 or 504 here.
21314
21315 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021316 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021317 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21318 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21319 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21320
21321 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21322 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021323 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021324 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021325 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021326
21327 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21328 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21329 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21330 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21331 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21332 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021333 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021334
21335 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21336 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21337 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21338 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21339 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21340 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21341 solution is to fix the application.
21342
21343 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21344 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21345 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21346 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21347 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21348 external attacks.
21349
21350 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021351 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021352 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021353 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21354 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21355
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021356 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21357 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21358 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021359 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021360 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021361
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021362 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21363 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21364 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21365 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021366 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21367 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21368 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21369 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021370 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21371 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21372 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21373 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021374
21375 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21376 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21377 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021378 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21379 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21380 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21381 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021382
21383 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21384 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21385 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21386 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21387
21388 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21389 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21390 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21391 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21392
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021393The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021394persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021395important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21396re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21397
21398 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21399
21400 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21401 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21402 set on a GET request.
21403
21404 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21405 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021406 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021407 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21408
21409 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21410 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21411 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21412
21413 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21414 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21415 already got a cookie.
21416
21417 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21418 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21419 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21420 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21421 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21422
21423 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21424 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21425 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21426
21427 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21428 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21429 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21430
21431 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21432 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21433
21434 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21435 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21436 then advertised in the response.
21437
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214398.6. Non-printable characters
21440-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021441
21442In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21443consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21444converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21445prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21446being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21447escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21448is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21449'}' when logging headers.
21450
21451Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21452issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21453containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21454
21455Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21456the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21457performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21458
21459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214608.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21461---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021462
21463Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21464achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021465section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021466cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21467the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21468the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021469locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021470not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21471user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21472a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21473wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21474
21475 Examples :
21476 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21477 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21478
21479 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21480 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21481
21482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214838.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21484---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021485
21486Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21487proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21488the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21489server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21490
21491Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21492response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021493section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021494
21495It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021496time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21497appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021498are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21499and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21500follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21501request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21502in the logs.
21503
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021504As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21505frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21506an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21507
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021508 Example :
21509 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21510 listen proxy-out
21511 mode http
21512 option httplog
21513 option logasap
21514 log global
21515 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21516
21517 # log the name of the virtual server
21518 capture request header Host len 20
21519
21520 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21521 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21522
21523 # log the beginning of the referrer
21524 capture request header Referer len 20
21525
21526 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21527 capture response header Server len 20
21528
21529 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21530 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21531
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021532 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021533 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21534
21535 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21536 capture response header Via len 20
21537
21538 # log the URL location during a redirection
21539 capture response header Location len 20
21540
21541 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21542 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21543 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21544 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21545 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21546
21547 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21548 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21549 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21550 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021551 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021552
21553 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21554 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21555 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21556 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21557 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021558 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021559
21560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215618.9. Examples of logs
21562---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021563
21564These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21565them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21566reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21567
21568 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21569 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21570 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21571
21572 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21573 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21574
21575 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21576 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21577 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21578
21579 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21580 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21581
21582 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21583 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21584 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21585
21586 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021587 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021588 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21589 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21590
21591 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21592 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21593 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21594
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021595 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21596 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21597 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21598 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021599 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021600 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021601
21602 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021603 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021604
21605 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21606 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21607 Nothing was sent to any server.
21608
21609 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21610 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21611
21612 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21613 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021614 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021615 send a 408 return code to the client.
21616
21617 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21618 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21619
21620 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21621 5 seconds ("c----").
21622
21623 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21624 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021625 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021626
21627 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021628 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021629 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21630 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21631 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21632 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21633 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021634
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021635
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200216369. Supported filters
21637--------------------
21638
21639Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21640accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21641unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21642
21643See also : "filter"
21644
216459.1. Trace
21646----------
21647
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021648filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021649
21650 Arguments:
21651 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21652 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21653
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021654 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021655
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021656 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021657 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21658 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21659 amount of the parsed data.
21660
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021661 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021662
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021663This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21664callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21665information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21666filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21667
21668Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21669tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21670a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21671
21672
216739.2. HTTP compression
21674---------------------
21675
21676filter compression
21677
21678The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21679keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021680when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21681fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21682done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21683explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21684filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21685listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21686order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021687
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021688See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21689 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021690
21691
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216929.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21693--------------------------------------------
21694
21695filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21696
21697 Arguments :
21698
21699 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21700 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21701 parsed.
21702
21703 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21704 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21705 part must be placed in its own scope.
21706
21707The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21708external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021709streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021710exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21711also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21712
21713SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21714the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21715
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021716For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021717"doc/SPOE.txt".
21718
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217199.4. Cache
21720----------
21721
21722filter cache <name>
21723
21724 Arguments :
21725
21726 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21727
21728The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21729"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021730cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021731other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21732case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21733is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21734filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021735listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21736order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021737
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021738See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21739 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21740
21741
217429.5. Fcgi-app
21743-------------
21744
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021745filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021746
21747 Arguments :
21748
21749 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21750
21751The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21752request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21753reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21754used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21755implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21756used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21757fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21758used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21759order.
21760
21761See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21762 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21763
21764
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217659.6. OpenTracing
21766----------------
21767
21768The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21769HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21770of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21771Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21772
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021773This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021774
21775The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21776HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21777participates in the work of HAProxy.
21778
21779filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21780
21781 Arguments :
21782
21783 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21784 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21785 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21786 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21787 OpenTracing filters.
21788
21789 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21790 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21791 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21792 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21793 filter must have its own scope defined.
21794
21795More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021796of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021797
21798
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002179910. FastCGI applications
21800-------------------------
21801
21802HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21803feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21804the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21805FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21806servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21807FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21808backend.
21809
21810HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21811application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21812connection.
21813
2181410.1. Setup
21815-----------
21816
2181710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21818--------------------------
21819
21820fcgi-app <name>
21821 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21822 document root must be defined.
21823
21824acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21825 Declare or complete an access list.
21826
21827 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21828 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21829 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21830 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21831 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21832
21833docroot <path>
21834 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21835 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21836 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21837
21838index <script-name>
21839 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21840 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21841 is an optional setting.
21842
21843 Example :
21844 index index.php
21845
21846log-stderr global
21847log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021848 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021849 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21850
21851 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21852 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21853
21854pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21855 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21856 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21857 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21858
21859 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21860 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21861 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21862 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21863
21864 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21865 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21866
21867path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021868 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021869 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21870 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21871 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21872 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21873 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21874 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21875 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021876
21877 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021878 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021879 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21880 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21881 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21882 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021883
21884 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021885 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21886 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021887
21888option get-values
21889no option get-values
21890 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21891
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021892 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021893 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21894
21895 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21896 application will accept.
21897
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021898 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21899 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021900
21901 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021902 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021903 option is disabled.
21904
21905 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21906 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21907 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21908 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21909 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21910 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21911
21912option keep-conn
21913no option keep-conn
21914 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21915 sending a response.
21916
21917 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21918 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21919
21920option max-reqs <reqs>
21921 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21922 accept.
21923
21924 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21925 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21926 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21927 to 1.
21928
21929option mpxs-conns
21930no option mpxs-conns
21931 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21932
21933 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21934 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21935
21936set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21937 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21938 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21939 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21940 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21941
21942 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21943 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21944 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21945
21946 Example :
21947 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21948 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21949
21950 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21951
21952
2195310.1.2. Proxy section
21954---------------------
21955
21956use-fcgi-app <name>
21957 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21958
21959 Arguments :
21960 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21961
21962 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21963 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21964 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21965 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21966 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21967
21968 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21969 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21970 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21971 application are evaluated.
21972
21973
2197410.1.3. Example
21975---------------
21976
21977 frontend front-http
21978 mode http
21979 bind *:80
21980 bind *:
21981
21982 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21983 default_backend back-static
21984
21985 backend back-static
21986 mode http
21987 server www A.B.C.D:80
21988
21989 backend back-dynamic
21990 mode http
21991 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21992 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21993
21994 fcgi-app php-fpm
21995 log-stderr global
21996 option keep-conn
21997
21998 docroot /var/www/my-app
21999 index index.php
22000 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22001
22002
2200310.2. Default parameters
22004------------------------
22005
22006A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22007the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022008script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022009applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22010
22011 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22012 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22013 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22014 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22015 | | |
22016 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22017 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22018 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22019 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22020 | | application. |
22021 | | |
22022 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22023 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22024 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22025 | | |
22026 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22027 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22028 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22029 | | the application's configuration. |
22030 | | |
22031 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22032 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22033 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22034 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22035 | | |
22036 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22037 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22038 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22039 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22040 | | be defined. |
22041 | | |
22042 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22043 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22044 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22045 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22046 | | is not set too. |
22047 | | |
22048 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22049 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22050 | | set. |
22051 | | |
22052 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22053 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22054 | | the request. |
22055 | | |
22056 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22057 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22058 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22059 | | |
22060 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22061 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22062 | | script to process the request. |
22063 | | |
22064 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22065 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22066 | | |
22067 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22068 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22069 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22070 | | |
22071 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22072 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22073 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22074 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22075 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22076 | | |
22077 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22078 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22079 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22080 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22081 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22082 | | side. |
22083 | | |
22084 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22085 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22086 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22087 | | connected to. |
22088 | | |
22089 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22090 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22091 | | |
22092 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022093 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22094 | | current HAProxy version. |
22095 | | |
22096 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022097 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22098 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22099 | | |
22100 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22101
22102
2210310.3. Limitations
22104------------------
22105
22106The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22107way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22108during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22109establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22110application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22111or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22112message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22113these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22114and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22115
22116Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22117request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22118requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22119
22120About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22121into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22122fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22123"http-request" ones.
22124
22125Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22126FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22127processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22128must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22129here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022131
2213211. Address formats
22133-------------------
22134
22135Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22136address.
22137
22138This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22139The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22140of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22141equivalent is '::'.
22142
22143Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22144is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22145
22146This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22147family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22148
22149Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22150configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22151use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22152'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22153
22154Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22155socket type and the transport method.
22156
22157
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002215811.1. Address family prefixes
22159-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022160
22161'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22162
22163'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22164 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22165 listening.
22166
22167'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22168 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22169 on the statement using this address, a port or
22170 a port range may or must be specified.
22171
22172'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22173 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22174 using this address, a port or a port range
22175 may or must be specified.
22176
22177'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22178 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22179 using this address, a port or a port range
22180 may or must be specified.
22181
22182'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22183 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22184 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22185 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22186 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22187 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22188
22189'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22190 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22191 start by slash '/'.
22192
22193
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002219411.2. Socket type prefixes
22195--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022196
22197Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22198type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22199this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22200This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22201but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22202
22203Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022204instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022205
22206If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22207they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22208report this to the maintainers.
22209
22210'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22211 to "stream"
22212
22213'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22214 to "datagram".
22215
22216
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002221711.3. Protocol prefixes
22218-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022219
22220'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22221 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22222 socket type and transport method is forced to
22223 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22224 this address, a port or a port range can or
22225 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22226 of 'stream+ip@'.
22227
22228'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22229 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22230 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22231 statement using this address, a port or port
22232 range can or must be specified.
22233 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22234
22235'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22236 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22237 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22238 statement using this address, a port or port
22239 range can or must be specified.
22240 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22241
22242'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22243 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22244 socket type and transport method is forced to
22245 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22246 this address, a port or a port range can or
22247 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22248 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22249
22250'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22251 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22252 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22253 the statement using this address, a port or
22254 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022255 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022256
22257'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22258 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22259 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22260 the statement using this address, a port or
22261 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022262 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022263
22264'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22265 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22266 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22267
22268'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22269 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22270 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22271
22272In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22273QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022275/*
22276 * Local variables:
22277 * fill-column: 79
22278 * End:
22279 */